3B21D Computer Common Systems
3B21D Computer Common Systems
Common Systems
Growth/Retrofit Tasks
254-303-100
Issue 2
October 1998
Copyright 1998 Lucent Technologies. All Rights Reserved.
This Information Product (IP) is protected by the copyright laws of the United States and other countries. It
may not be reproduced, distributed, or altered in any fashion by any entity, including other Lucent
Technologies Business Units or Divisions, without express written consent. For permission to reproduce or
distribute, call 1-888-LTINFO6 (1-888-584-6366).
Notice
Every effort was made to ensure that the information contained in this IP was complete and accurate at the
time of printing. However, information is subject to change.
This IP describes certain hardware, software, features, and capabilities of Lucent Technologies products.
This IP is for information purposes, and you are cautioned that the hardware, software, features, and
capabilities described herein may not be the same as the product you have.
Trademarks
5ESS is a registered trademark of Lucent Technologies.
UNIX is a registered trademark in the United States and other countries, licensed exclusively through
X/Open Company Limited.
All other trademarks are identified as they appear in the text.
Ordering Information
This IP is distributed by the Lucent Technologies Customer Information Center in Indianapolis, Indiana.
Orders for additional copies may be placed from the continental United States by calling 1-888-LUCENT-8
(1-888-582-3688) or faxing to 1-800-566-9568. Customers outside the continental United States may place
orders by contacting the in-country Lucent Technologies market manager. Lucent Technologies personnel
outside the continental United States can order additional copies by faxing to 1-317-322-6699.
Acknowledgment
Developed by Lucent Technologies Customer Training and Information Products.
How Are We Doing?
Title: 3B21D Computer Common Systems Growth/Retrofit Tasks
Not
Excellent Good Fair Poor Applicable
Ease of Use /////////////////////
Clarity /////////////////////
Completeness /////////////////////
Accuracy /////////////////////
Organization /////////////////////
Appearance /////////////////////
Examples
Illustrations
Overall Satisfaction /////////////////////
2. Please check the ways you feel we could improve this IP:
If we may contact you concerning your comments, please complete the following:
Name: Telephone Number:
Company/Organization: Date:
Address:
When you have completed this form, please fold, tape, and return to address on back
or Fax to: 336-727-3043.
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------Do Not Cut—Fold Here And Tape ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
NO POSTAGE
NECESSARY
IF MAILED
IN THE
UNITED STATES
DOCUMENTATION SERVICES
2400 Reynolda Road
Winston-Salem, NC 27199-2029
How Are We Doing?
Title: 3B21D Computer Common Systems Growth/Retrofit Tasks
Not
Excellent Good Fair Poor Applicable
Ease of Use /////////////////////
Clarity /////////////////////
Completeness /////////////////////
Accuracy /////////////////////
Organization /////////////////////
Appearance /////////////////////
Examples
Illustrations
Overall Satisfaction /////////////////////
2. Please check the ways you feel we could improve this IP:
If we may contact you concerning your comments, please complete the following:
Name: Telephone Number:
Company/Organization: Date:
Address:
When you have completed this form, please fold, tape, and return to address on back
or Fax to: 336-727-3043.
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------Do Not Cut—Fold Here And Tape ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
NO POSTAGE
NECESSARY
IF MAILED
IN THE
UNITED STATES
DOCUMENTATION SERVICES
2400 Reynolda Road
Winston-Salem, NC 27199-2029
Contents
30 UC Degrowth 30-1
Introduction 30-1
Prerequisite Conditions 30-1
References 30-2
Procedure 30-2
31 UC Growth 31-1
Introduction 31-1
Prerequisite Conditions 31-1
References 31-2
Procedure 31-2
Glossary GL-1
Index IN-1
12 Memory Growth
12-1. KLWmm Circuit Pack 12-10
5 DFC Growth
5-1. DFC/SBUS Number Assignment
Convention 5-5
5-2. Default ucb Form Field Values for DFC 5-6
5-3. Field 27 Values for DFC 5-7
5-4. Field 66 Values for DFC 5-7
5-5. Default mdct Form Field Values 5-8
5-6. Default ucb Form Field Values for First and
Second SBUS 5-10
5-7. Field 27 Values for First and Second
SBUS 5-10
5-8. Field 66 Values for Second SBUS 5-11
6 DMAC/DSCH Growth
6-1. DMA 0 DSCH Assignments (Cable
Table) 6-2
6-2. DMA 1 DSCH Assignments (Cable
Table) 6-3
7 HSDC Degrowth
7-1. IOPPS EQLs 7-12
8 HSDC Growth
8-1. Default ucb Form Field Values 8-6
8-2. Default mdct Form Field Values 8-7
8-3. IOPPS EQLs 8-10
12 Memory Growth
12-1. btparm Form Pages Values 12-4
12-2. Equipage Values 12-11
16 SCSDC Degrowth
16-1. IOPPS EQLs 16-11
17 SCSDC Growth
17-1. Default ucb Form Field Values 17-6
17-2. Default mdct Form Field Values 17-7
17-3. IOPPS EQLs 17-10
Purpose
This Information Product (IP) is part of a documentation set used to support the UNIX
Real-Time Reliable (RTR) system running on the Lucent Technologies 3B21D computer. It
presents the procedures used to grow, degrow, and retrofit major components of the 3B21D
computer.
Audience
This IP provides information for a variety of audiences. Anyone interested in the UNIX RTR
operating system and the 3B21D computer will find this IP useful; however, the primary
audience includes the following:
Software developers
Hardware developers
Training course developers
System administrators
3B21D computer system personnel responsible for system engineering,
maintenance, operations, and installation.
This IP is being reissued to incorporate new information for the 3B21D computer and to
bring the IP into compliance with new Lucent Technologies documentation standards.
Eleven chapters and Appendix A have been added to this IP. All chapters include both
technical and editorial changes and have been reorganized in alphabetical order by chapter
title. Major changes have been made in Chapter 12.
The procedures in this IP are easy to use for both the experienced and inexperienced user.
Steps requiring a more complicated action have ‘‘subprocedures’’ that provide detailed
instructions.
If you know how, you can perform the action described in the main procedure step,
skip (or ‘‘bypass’’) the subprocedure steps, and continue to the next main procedure
step.
If you need help, perform the steps detailed in the subprocedure.
Each subprocedure is set off from the main procedure by double bold horizontal lines that
mark the beginning of the subprocedure and double narrow horizontal lines that mark the
ending.
Figure 1 shows how bypassing works. If you know how to remove the MHD from service
(Step 3), you can perform the action (without having to read Steps 3.1 and 3.2), and then
skip to Step 4. If you do not know how to remove the MHD from service, you should read
and perform the instructions given in Steps 3.1 and 3.2, and then continue to Step 4.
Numbering Conventions
The first step in a main procedure is Step 1 as shown in Figure 1. For example:
The first step in a subprocedure is X.1. The X varies depending on where in the main
procedure the subprocedure step occurs. For example, if we added a subprocedure step
after the main procedure Step 3, the first number of the subprocedure would be 3.1. See
Figure 1 for an example.
NOTE:
If the green RQIP LED begins to flash and then
extinguishes, the request to go out of service was
Bypass the sub- not accepted by the system. Check the Receive-
procedure if you Only Printer (ROP) or Maintenance Teletypewriter
know how to (MTTY) for messages.
remove the MHD
from service. 3.2. Wait for the unit to go out of service.
Conventions Used
The input commands contained in this IP are listed in both Man-Machine Language and
Program Documentation Standard (PDS) format. For example, a step instructing the user
to enter the appropriate input command to the system would include both formats as
follows:
If MML, VFY:MHD=b;
If PDS, VFY:MHD b!
The following notations are used to show commands, filenames, variables, screen displays,
lines that are too long to be shown as they actually appear, and return keys in the text and
displays.
NOTE:
System filenames and command names are case-sensitive, so you must enter them
exactly as they are shown.
Command names in text appear in bold type; for example, the /usr/bin/ls command.
Command names in headings appear in bold type.
NOTE:
Due to the possibility of errors when entering a command, punctuation has
been alleviated at the end of a command line unless the punctuation is part of
that command.
Filenames, forms, and record names in text appear in italic type; for example, the
/usr/lib/uucp/System file, the scsdbody form, or the sgen record. Filenames, forms,
and record names in headings appear in bold-italic type.
Text that you enter such as a command or a response to a prompt appears in bold
type; for example, the ls -la command. The convention of making text bold
overrides other conventions; for example, enter scsdbody for the form name.
NOTE:
Due to the possibility of errors (comparing actual response with instructions),
punctuation has been alleviated at the end of a response unless the
punctuation is part of that response.
Variables that appear in a command line or file appear in italic type; for example,
grep username /etc/passwd. In this example, username is a variable indicating a
user’s name is required.
Screen displays and system messages appear in constant width type; for
example, Please enter your password. Program code listings and file
listings are also shown in constant width type. Input messages are shown in
constant-width bold type.
Comments and explanations within a display are indented and shown in italic type.
These are for information only and will not appear on your screen.
A line in a file or on the computer screen that is too long to be shown as it actually
appears in this IP will be shown with a backslash ( \ ) at the end of the first line. This
indicates the next line should be read as a continuation of the current line.
Square brackets around an argument on a command line indicate that the argument
is optional; for example, the lpstat [-t] command. In this example, the -t argument is
optional and can be omitted.
A vertical bar ( | ) between words in an argument on a command line indicates that
one of the arguments is to be selected.
The key identified on your keyboard as Return, Enter, or a bent arrow (←| ) is
referred to as the Return key. Occasionally, representations of this Return key will
be boxed; for example, Return .
There is an implied Return at the end of each command and menu response that you
enter. Some examples do not explicitly show the Return. Where you may be
expected to enter a Return (as in the case where you are accepting a menu default),
the symbol <CR> is shown to indicate that you are to press the Return key.
Key combinations appear in a hyphenated format; for example, Ctrl-d. Press and
hold down the first key of a key combination while pressing the second key.
Ellipses (three dots) on a command line indicate that the previous argument can be
repeated; for example, ls [file ...]. In this example, multiple files can be listed after
the command.
References to manual pages are followed by their manual page location number in
parentheses; for example, mount(1M).
Hexadecimal Notation
Hexadecimal (base 16) numbers are denoted with a 0x prefix; for example, 0x00A is
decimal 10.
Equipment Locations
A coordinate numbering system is used to identify the Equipment Location (EQL) in units
and cabinets. The origin is the lower left front of the cabinet or unit. Vertical increments are
measured in inches. Horizontal increments are measured in eighths of an inch. The
coordinate location of a circuit pack is expressed as the horizontal and vertical location of
the center lines of the connector into which the circuit pack is inserted. The location of a
unit in a cabinet is identified by the placement of the lower left corner of the unit in the
cabinet.
For example, a connector at EQL 004-080 is located 4 inches above the origin and
10 inches (80 x 0.125 = 10.0) to the right of the origin.
Safety Labels
Safety labels are reminders used to assure the safety of personnel and to minimize service
interruptions, loss of data, and damage to equipment, products, and software.
Three types of safety labels are used in Lucent Technologies documentation. The three
types, in descending order of priority, are as follows:
1. DANGER indicates the presence of a hazard that will cause death or severe
personal injury if the hazard is not avoided.
2. WARNING indicates the presence of a hazard that can cause death or severe
personal injury if the hazard is not avoided.
3. CAUTION indicates the presence of a hazard that will or can cause minor personal
injury or property damage if the hazard is not avoided.
Table 1 lists by IP number and Select Code the Lucent Technologies IPs supporting the
3B21D computer.
NEW OLD
IP SELECT TITLE
NUMBER CODE
254-303-100 - 3B21D Computer
Growth/Retrofit Tasks
254-303-101 - 3B21D Computer
Routine Maintenance Tasks
254-303-102 - 3B21D Computer
Trouble Clearing Tasks
254-303-103 303-007 3B20D and 3B21D Computers
UNIX RTR Operating System
Processor Recovery Messages Guide
254-303-104 303-010 3B20D and 3B21D Computers
UNIX RTR Operating System
Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-105 304-045 3B21D Computer
Hardware Reference Manual
254-303-106 304-046 3B20D and 3B21D Computers
UNIX RTR Operating System
System Maintenance Manual
254-303-107 303-072 3B20D and 3B21D Computers
UNIX RTR Operating System
Software Troubleshooting Guide
254-303-110 303-080 3B20D and 3B21D Computers
UNIX RTR Operating System
PDS Input Messages Manual
254-303-111 303-081 3B20D and 3B21D Computers
UNIX RTR Operating System
PDS Output Messages Manual
254-303-112 303-082 3B20D and 3B21D Computers
UNIX RTR Operating System
MML Input Messages Manual
254-303-113 303-083 3B20D and 3B21D Computers
UNIX RTR Operating System
MML Output Messages Manual
IP references will not include full titles; for example, ‘‘Refer to 254-303-104, Recent Change
and Verify Manual, for more information.’’
Lucent Technologies welcomes your comments on this IP. Your comments will aid us in
improving the quality and usefulness of Lucent Technologies documentation. Please use
the Feedback Form provided at the front of this IP. If the Feedback Form is missing, mail
your comments to the following address:
Lucent Technologies
Customer Training and Information Products (CTIP)
2400 Reynolda Road
Winston-Salem, NC 27106-4606
The 3B21D computer is used as the Administrative Module (AM) in various switching
system applications and is not provided as a stand-alone product. Therefore, the
application documentation is responsible for providing this information.
1
Contents
Introduction 1-1
Prerequisite Conditions 1-2
References 1-3
Procedure 1-3
1
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow the Dual Serial Channel (DSCH)
Computer Interconnect (DCI) from a 3B21D computer system via high-level mode Recent
Change and Verify (RC/V). The DCI feature provides a high-throughput interface to transfer
data between a 3B21D computer and an adjunct processor. The DCI feature is supported
beginning with Real-Time Reliable (RTR) Release 21.3 and later field releases, but the
high-level degrowth procedure is only available in RTR Release 21.17 or later software
releases.
Information on installing the DCI board in the adjunct processor may be found in the adjunct
processor hardware owner’s guide.
During the high-level Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) session, the system will prompt for
diagnostics, removals, and restorals of equipment.
If the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY) is used, pressing the CMD/MSG key
enables messages to be entered at the same terminal.
If an RC/V terminal is used, another terminal is needed to input the requested
messages.
NOTE 1:
If using the MTTY to return to the Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) RC/V
session, press the CMD/MSG key twice - once to access the command mode where
graphic displays could be viewed and the second time to return to the ECD RC/V
session.
NOTE 2:
This procedure does not update rootdmly.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
On the 3B21D computer:
— RTR Release 21.17 or later software release must be installed on the 3B21D
computer. The dci delete (dcidel) high-level form is not available before
Release 21.17; therefore, the low-level DCI degrowth procedure must be used
for releases prior to Release 21.17.
— All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
— No system update activity should be taking place when performing this
procedure.
— On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48
hours and should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the
Control Unit (CU), Disk File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors
(IOPs), Moving Head Disks (MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
— Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not
experienced any terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or
overloads.
— The root ECD must be consistent with the incore ECD.
* Sun, Sun Microsystems, the Sun Logo, Solaris, and SunOS are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Sun Microsystems Inc. in the United States and other countries.
† All SPARC trademarks are used under license and are trademarks or registered
trademarks of SPARC International Inc. in the United States and other countries. Products
bearing SPARC trademarks are based upon an architecture developed by Sun
Microsystems Inc.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual
Adjunct processor hardware owner’s guide.
Procedure
The following steps describe the DCI high-level mode degrowth procedure:
1. At the MTTY, inhibit Routine Exercises (REXs) by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode (Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. Invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the command
mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
3.3. Enter the unit_name and unit_number values for the DCI (in capitals)
being degrown as provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading...Please wait...
followed by Enter, Delete, Validate, or Print:
3.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting ... in the upper right
corner of the screen and prompts you to remove the
DCI from service.
NOTE:
The system begins to make changes to the incore ECD in
response to the data input on the dcidel form. Messages flash on
the screen indicating the database actions currently in progress.
5. At the MTTY, remove the degrowth DCI from service by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, RMV:DCI=a;
If PDS, RMV:DCI a!
6. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821 [at Equipment Location (EQL)
53-060], remove CU 1 from service by operating the ROS/RST switch to the ROS
position.
NOTE:
Step 6 prevents automatic restoral of the CU 1 when the unit is powered up
later in this procedure.
7. Force CU 0 on-line.
! CAUTION:
The system could sustain a severe maintenance reset while CU 0
is unavailable.
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 1 displays a Force Off-Line (FOFL) indicator and
CU 0 displays a Force On-Line (FONL) indicator.
7.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
8. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), power down CU 1 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
9.2. Disconnect the adjunct processor end of the DCI cable from the adjunct
processor.
NOTE:
This response means the DCI is now unequipped, but the
procedure must be completed to update the database.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
10.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then extinguish before
continuing to Step 11.2.
11.3. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 1 in progress and wait until CU 1 is restored to standby before
continuing.
13. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove CU 0 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 13 prevents automatic restoral of CU 0 when the unit is powered up later
in this procedure.
! CAUTION:
The system could sustain a severe maintenance reset while CU 1
is unavailable.
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 0 displays an FOFL indicator and CU 1 displays
an FONL indicator.
14.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the normal
display.
15. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), power down CU 0 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 0
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
16. Disconnect the DCI cable from CU 0 and remove the 993A DCI Small Computer
System Interface (SCSI) Bus (SBUS) card from the adjunct processor.
! CAUTION:
Before removing the DCI board from the adjunct processor, make
sure the system power switch is in the OFF (0) position. When
the power is off, the green LED on the front panel is not lit and the
fans are not running.
16.2. Disconnect the adjunct processor end of the DCI cable from the adjunct
processor.
16.3. Remove the DCI board from the adjunct processor as specified in the
adjunct processor hardware owner’s guide.
NOTE:
The dcidel session running on the RC/V terminal indicates which unit to
remove. Wait for the unit to be removed from service before continuing.
18. At the MTTY, restore the PLU to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
19.3 At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the normal
display.
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then to extinguish before
continuing to Step 20.2.
20.3. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 0 in progress and wait until CU 0 is restored to standby before
continuing.
21.5 Enter e
Response: The system flashes executing... FORM EXECUTED
once and displays the Enter Form Name:
22.4. Verify that the process is stopped by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, STP:EXC:DATA,USER,FN="/cft/dap/dcidip";
If PDS, STOP:EXC:USER,FN"/cft/dap/dcidip"!
NOTE:
The STOP EXC USER STOPPED response
may be followed by a killp warning that can be
ignored.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
25. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
26. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
2
Contents
Introduction 2-1
Prerequisite Conditions 2-2
References 2-3
Procedure 2-3
2
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow the Dual Serial Channel (DSCH)
Computer Interconnect (DCI) into a 3B21D computer system via high-level mode Recent
Change and Verify (RC/V). The DCI feature provides a high-throughput interface to transfer
data between a 3B21D computer and an adjunct processor. The DCI feature is supported
in Real-Time Reliable (RTR) Release 21.3 and later field releases, but the high-level growth
procedure is only available in RTR Release 21.17 or later software releases.
Information on installing the DCI board in the adjunct processor may be found in the adjunct
processor hardware owner’s guide.
During the high-level Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) session, the system will prompt for
diagnostics, removals, and restorals of equipment.
If the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY) is used, pressing the CMD/MSG key
enables messages to be entered at the same terminal.
If an RC/V terminal is used, another terminal is needed to input the requested
messages.
NOTE 1:
If using the MTTY to return to the Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) RC/V
session, press the CMD/MSG key twice - once to access the command mode where
graphic displays could be viewed and the second time to return to the ECD RC/V
session.
NOTE 2:
This procedure does not update rootdmly.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
On the 3B21D computer:
— RTR Release 21.17 or later software must be installed on the 3B21D
computer. The addition of dci (dciadd) high-level form is not available before
Release 21.17; therefore, the low-level DCI growth procedure must be used
for releases prior to Release 21.17.
— All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
— No system update activity should be taking place when performing this
procedure.
— On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48
hours and should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the
Control Unit (CU), Disk File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors
(IOPs), Moving Head Disks (MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
— Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not
experienced any terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or
overloads.
— The root ECD must be consistent with the incore ECD.
* Sun, Sun Microsystems, the Sun Logo, Solaris, and SunOS are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Sun Microsystems Inc. in the United States and other countries.
† All SPARC trademarks are used under license and are trademarks or registered
trademarks of SPARC International Inc. in the United States and other countries. Products
bearing SPARC trademarks are based upon an architecture developed by Sun
Microsystems Inc.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual
Adjunct processor hardware owner’s guide.
Procedure
The following steps describe the DCI high-level mode growth procedure:
1. At the MTTY, inhibit Routine Exercises (REXs) by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL
2. Invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode (Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. Invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the command
mode.
3.2. Enter the unit_name and unit_number values for the DCI (in capitals)
being grown as provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Enter Insert, Change,
Substitute, Validate, or Print:
3.3. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting ...
NOTE:
The system begins to make changes to the incore ECD in
response to the data input on the dciadd form. Messages flash on
the screen indicating the database actions currently in progress.
5. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821 [at Equipment Location (EQL)
53-060], remove CU 1 from service by operating the ROS/RST switch to the ROS
position.
NOTE:
Step 5 provides automatic restoral of the CU 1 when the unit is powered up
later in procedure.
Response: The system displays RMV CU 1 COMPLETED
6. Force CU 0 on-line.
! CAUTION:
The system could sustain a severe maintenance reset while CU 1
is unavailable.
6.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
7. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), power down CU 1 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
8. Connect the DCI cable and install the DCI card for CU 1.
NOTE:
For assistance in mounting and grounding the DSCH cables, see
Figure 2-1.
8.2. Install the DCI board in the adjunct processor as specified in the adjunct
processor hardware owner’s guide.
8.3. Connect the end of the DCI cable to the adjunct processor.
8.4. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key.
Response: The system begins to make changes to the incore
ECD in response to the data input on the dciadd
form. Messages flash on the screen indicating the
database actions currently in progress.
Figure 2-1. DSCH Cables Grounding and Mounting for DCI Feature
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
9.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then extinguish before
continuing to Step 10.2.
10.3. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 1 in progress and wait until CU 1 is restored to standby before
continuing.
10.4. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key.
Response: The system displays REPT DCI a in growth state.
Where: a = unit name of the growth DCI.
12. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove CU 0 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 12 prevents automatic restoral of the CU 0 when the unit is powered up
later in this procedure.
! CAUTION:
The system could sustain a severe maintenance reset while CU 0
is unavailable.
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 0 displays an FOFL indicator and CU 1 displays
an FONL indicator.
13.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
14. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), power down CU 0 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 0
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
NOTE:
The dciadd session running on the RC/V terminal indicates which
unit to remove. Wait for the unit to be removed from service before
continuing.
17. At the MTTY, restore PLU to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
18.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then to extinguish before
continuing to Step 19.2.
19.3. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 0 in progress and wait until CU 0 is restored to standby before
continuing.
20. At the MTTY, diagnose the growth DCI with CU 1 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:DCI=a;
If PDS, DGN:DCI a!
21. At the MTTY, switch the CUs by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, either 400 Poke command or SW:CU;
If PDS, either 400 Poke command or SW:CU!
23. At the MTTY, restore the DCI device to service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RST:DCI=a;
If PDS, RST:DCI a!
25. Verify page is up for DCI Display Process (DCIDIP). At MTTY CPDP 100, select
108
Response: The CPDP 108 shows the DCIs that were added.
26.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
28. Invoke the sg database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVSG,DB="root",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVSG,DB "root",NREVIEW!
29.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
Update the sgen2 record to add a block device "j" (bdj) driver.
30.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the ksgen: attribute.
30.4. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
30.5. Enter 10
Response: The system displays row:
30.6. Enter a
Where: a = next available row.
30.10. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the sgen2: attribute.
31.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
32. At the MTTY, build boot image by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, UPD:BLDBOOT:DATA, BOOTIMAGE="/appdmert";
If PDS, UPD:BLDBOOT:BOOTIMAGE "/appdmert"!
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
34. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
35. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
3
Contents
Introduction 3-1
Prerequisite Conditions 3-1
References 3-2
Procedure 3-2
3
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow the Dual Serial Channel (DSCH)
Computer Interconnect (DCI) from a 3B21D computer system via low-level mode Recent
Change and Verify (RC/V). The DCI feature provides a high-throughput interface to transfer
data between a 3B21D computer and an adjunct processor. The DCI feature is supported
in Real-Time Reliable (RTR) Release 21.3 and later field releases. When using this
degrowth with software releases before Release 21.17, the channel option (chopt) form will
be deleted. For Release 21.17 or later, the dci option (dciopt) form will be deleted.
NOTE:
This procedure does not update rootdmly.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 24 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
If the adjunct processor is a Sun* SPARCstation†:
— The Sun SPARCstation should be running SunOS* System V Release 4.0
(SVR4) (Solaris* 2.X) or later releases.
— The Sun SPARCstation software to support the DCI feature should have been
installed via installation instructions defined in 254-303-106, System
Maintenance Manual.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual
Adjunct processor hardware owner’s guide.
Procedure
The following steps describe the DCI low-level mode degrowth procedure:
1. At the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY), inhibit automatic maintenance requests
by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
* Sun, Sun Microsystems, the Sun Logo, Solaris, and SunOS are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Sun Microsystems Inc. in the United States and other countries.
† All SPARC trademarks are used under license and are trademarks or registered
trademarks of SPARC International Inc. in the United States and other countries.
Products bearing SPARC trademarks are based upon an architecture developed by Sun
Microsystems Inc.
2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
NOTE:
The following subprocedure provides the Unit Control Block (UCB) linkage for
channel subdevices from which the DCI will be degrown. If the DCI to be
removed is not the first device under the specified channel, the Previous
Logical Unit (PLU) to the DCI will have to be removed in Step 33 in order to
update the side pointer linkages to bypass the DCI device. For use later in this
procedure, the following subprocedure also provides the UCB pointer list which
shows the forms which must be removed and the Minor Device Chain Table
(MDCT) pointer list which provides the logical device (logdev) records
associated with the DCI device being degrown.
3.3. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
3.4. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
3.5. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
3.6. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
3.7. Enter aa
Where: aa = channel number from which the DCI will be degrown.
3.9. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the form_type: attribute.
3.14. Enter aa
Where: aa = unit number of the DCI being removed.
3.15. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
4. At the MTTY, request hard copies of the forms from the ROP by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
5. At the MTTY, remove the DCI unit by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:DCI=a;
If PDS, RMV:DCI a!
6.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
7.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
7.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DCI being degrown.
7.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
7.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
7.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
8.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
9. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821 [at Equipment Location (EQL)
28-060], remove CU 0 from service by operating the ROS/RST switch to the ROS
position.
NOTE:
Step 9 prevents automatic restoral of CU 0 when the unit is powered up later in
this procedure.
11. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), power down CU 0 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 0
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
13.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
14. Determine the PLU status by referring to the ROP output obtained in Step 4. If the
growth DCI is the first device under this channel, continue to Step 15; otherwise, go
to Step 16.
15. Update the DSCH down pointer and the DCI up pointer linkages.
15.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
15.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
15.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
15.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
15.6. Enter aa
Where: aa = channel number from which the DCI is being
degrown.
15.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.8. Enter 36
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_name:
attribute.
15.9. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_number:
attribute.
15.10. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
15.11. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_number:
attribute.
15.12. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
15.18. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DCI being degrown.
15.19. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.20. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
15.21. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_number:
attribute.
15.22. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
15.23. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
15.24. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.26. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
16.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
17. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), restore power to CU 0 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED CU 0
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
18.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the Common
Processor Display Page (CPDP).
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics pass and the CU has been marked
standby.
20.2. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
21. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), remove CU 1 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 21 prevents automatic restoral of the CU 1 when the unit is powered up
later in this procedure.
23. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), power down CU 1 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
24. Disconnect the DCI cable and the Small Computer System Interface (SCSI) Bus
(SBUS) card for CU 1.
25.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
26. Determine the PLU status by referring to the ROP output obtained in Step 4. If the
growth DCI is the first device under this channel, continue to Step 27; otherwise, go
to Step 28.
27. Update the DSCH down pointer and the DCI up pointer linkages.
27.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
27.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
27.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
27.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
27.6. Enter aa
Where: aa = channel number from which the DCI is being
degrown.
27.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
27.8. Enter 36
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_name:
attribute.
27.9. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_number:
attribute.
27.10. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
27.11. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_number:
attribute.
27.12. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
27.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
27.18. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DCI being degrown.
27.19. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
27.20. Enter 51
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_name:
attribute.
27.21. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_number:
attribute.
27.22. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 unit_name:
attribute.
27.23. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 unit_number:
attribute.
27.24. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
27.26. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
28.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
29. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), restore power to CU 1 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED CU 1
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics pass and the CU has been marked
standby.
32. Determine the PLU status by referring to the ROP output obtained in Step 4. If the
DCI is the first device under the specified channel, go to Step 39; otherwise, continue
to Step 33.
33. At the MTTY, remove the PLU from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:a=b ;
If PDS, RMV:a b !
34.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
35. Update the PLU Unit Control Block (UCB) side pointer to bypass the DCI.
35.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
35.5. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
35.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
35.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
35.8. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
35.9. Enter aa
Where: aa = Next Logical Unit (NLU) name (see output from
Step 4) or NULL if the DCI is the last device.
35.10. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
35.11. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the NLU or NULL if the DCI is the last
device.
35.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
36. Update the DCI UCB controller pointers and side pointers.
36.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DCI being degrown.
36.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
36.6. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
36.7. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
36.8. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
36.9. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
36.10. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
36.11. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_number:
attribute.
36.12. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
36.13. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
36.14. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
36.15. Enter 51
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_name:
attribute.
36.16. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_number:
attribute.
36.17. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 unit_name:
attribute.
36.18. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 unit_number:
attribute.
36.19. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
36.21. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
37.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
38. At the MTTY, restore the PLU to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:a=b ;
If PDS, RST:a b !
39.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
Delete the ECD records for the DCI in the order given in the following procedure. The
logdev records must be removed first, followed by the minor device chain table (mdct)
records, then the remaining records as specified in the procedure. Removing the
records in this order prevents ‘‘outstanding reference’’ database errors. The class
definition (classdef) form must also be updated to remove DCDRVLOG.
40. Delete the ECD records associated with the DCI using the logdev form.
40.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the logical_name: attribute.
40.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting… FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the logical_name: attribute.
40.5. Repeat Steps 40.1 through 40.4 for each logdev record.
Response: The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
41. Delete the ECD records associated with the DCI using the mdct record.
NOTE:
Two mdct records are used for each DCI. One record is used for diagnostics,
and the other record is used for normal operations. Repeat Steps 41.1 through
41.5 to delete each mdct record.
41.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
41.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting… FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
42. Delete the ECD records associated with the DCI using the unit control block (ucb)
form.
42.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
42.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting… FORM DELETED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
NOTE:
If using releases prior to Release 21.17, delete the channel option (chopt) form.
43. Delete the ECD records associated with the DCI using the chopt form.
43.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
43.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting… FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
NOTE:
If using Release 21.17 or later, delete the dci option (dciopt) form.
44. Delete the ECD records associated with the DCI using the dciopt form.
44.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
44.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting… FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
45. Delete the ECD records associated with the DCI using the error threshold (errthld)
form.
45.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the error_table: attribute.
45.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting… FORM DELETED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
46. Delete the ECD records associated with the DCI Display Process (DCIDIP) using the
device definition (device) form.
46.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the logical_devname:
attribute.
46.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting… FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the logical_devname:
attribute.
47. Delete the ECD records associated with the DCI using the classdef form.
47.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the class_name: attribute.
47.3. Enter 10
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, or Print:
47.4. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
47.5. Enter 3
Response: The system displays row:
47.6. Enter a
Where: a = row containing DCDRVLOG.
47.7. Enter ’
Response: The system displays row:
47.10. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the class_name: attribute.
48. Delete the ECD records associated with the DCIDIP using the user level automatic
restart process (ularp) form.
48.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the rec_name: attribute.
48.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting… FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the rec_name: attribute.
49.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
50.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
51.4. At the MTTY, verify that the process is stopped by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, STP:EXC:DATA,USER,FN="/cft/dap/dcidip";
If PDS, STOP:EXC:USER,FN"/cft/dap/dcidip"!
NOTE:
The STOP EXC USER STOPPED response may be followed by a killp
warning that can be ignored.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
54. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
55. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
4
Contents
Introduction 4-1
Prerequisite Conditions 4-2
References 4-3
Procedure 4-3
4
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow the Dual Serial Channel (DSCH)
Computer Interconnect (DCI) into a 3B21D computer system via low-level mode Recent
Change and Verify (RC/V). The DCI feature provides a high-throughput interface to transfer
data between a 3B21D computer and an adjunct processor. The DCI feature is supported
in Real-Time Reliable (RTR) Release 21.3 and later field releases. When using this growth
procedure with software releases before Release 21.17, the channel option (chopt) form
must be used. For Release 21.17 or later, the dci option (dciopt) form must be used.
NOTE:
This procedure does not update rootdmly.
The 3B21D computer software release must be installed on the system before this
growth procedure can take place. Information on installing the DCI board in the
adjunct processor may be found in the adjunct processor hardware owner’s guide.
Refer to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual, for installation procedures.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
On the 3B21D computer:
— RTR Release 21.3 or later software release must be installed on the 3B21D
computer.
— All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
— No system update activity should be taking place when performing this
procedure.
— On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run recently and should
have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
— Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not
experienced any terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or
overloads.
— The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with
the incore ECD.
* Sun, Sun Microsystems, the Sun Logo, Solaris, and SunOS are trademarks or registered
trademarks of Sun Microsystems Inc in the United States and other countries.
† All SPARC trademarks are used under license and are trademarks or registered
trademarks of SPARC International Inc. in the United States and other countries. Products
bearing SPARC trademarks are based upon an architecture developed by Sun
Microsystems Inc.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual
Adjunct processor hardware owner’s guide.
Procedure
The following steps describe the DCI low-level mode growth procedure:
1. At the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY), inhibit automatic maintenance requests
by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
NOTE:
The following subprocedure provides the Unit Control Block (UCB) linkage for
channel subdevices to which the DCI will be grown. If the growth DCI is not the
first device under the specified channel, the Previous Logical Unit (PLU) to the
DCI will have to be removed in Step 40 in order to update the side pointer
linkages to the DCI device.
3.3. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
3.4. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
3.5. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
3.6. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
3.7. Enter a
Where: a = channel number to which the DCI will be grown.
3.8. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
4. At the MTTY, request hard copies of the forms from the ROP by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
5.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
6. Insert the ECD records associated with the DCI using the unit control block (ucb)
form.
6.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
6.3. Populate all fields of the ucb form except fields 36 (down), 41 (side),
46 (cntrl_0), and 51 (cntrl_1). Table 4-1 contains values for fields that
are static and must be used for the DCI feature. All other field values
must be as provided by application engineering.
Field Value
11. device_port SNIC (RTR Release 21.3 only)
DCI (RTR Release 21.7 and later)
12. device_type SNIC (RTR Release 21.3 only)
DCI (RTR Release 21.7 and later)
13. internal_device Value from 0 - 3; assigned in numerical order
23. device_num DSCH port number that DCI is connected to
28. interrupt_num DSCH port number that DCI is connected to
27. mv 2 (for 3B21D computer)
30. pathname pu/dci
56. error_table Name of errthld record engineered for DCI
57. option_name Name of chopt record engineered for DCI
(before RTR Release 21.17)
Name of dciopt record engineered for DCI
(RTR Release 21.17 or later)
6.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate, screen#,
or Print:
NOTE:
The chopt form is only used in Releases 21.3 through 21.15. Release 21.17
must use the dciopt form.
7. Insert the ECD records associated with the DCI using the chopt form.
7.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
7.3. Only three fields of the chopt form are used by the DCI driver and are
described in Table 4-2. Populate these fields with information as
provided by application engineering.
Field Value
4. poll minimum polling period in milliseconds
5. time_out maximum polling period in milliseconds
6. picconf period in seconds to attempt to restore a DCI that is
removed because of excessive errors
7.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
NOTE:
The dciopt form must be used with Release 21.17 and later.
8. Insert the ECD records associated with the DCI using the dciopt form.
8.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
NOTE:
Field 1 — Option block name is the same as field 57 (option_name)
on the ucb form of the corresponding DCI. This is a key field.
Field 6 — dcitype — ‘‘1’’ indicates the DCI supports the High
Availability - Operations and Maintenance Platform (HA-OMP)
feature. All other DCI units must use the default value ‘‘0’’.
8.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
9. Insert the ECD records associated with the DCI using the minor device chain table
(mdct) form.
NOTE:
Two mdct records are needed for each DCI. One record is used for
diagnostics (diagnostic mdct record is used for all DCI devices equipped), and
the other record is used for normal operations.
9.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
9.3. Populate all fields of the mdct form. Static field values are described in
Table 4-3. Other field values must be as provided by application
engineering.
Field Value
2. logical_device dc
3. mdct_type "d" for diagnostic mdct
"T" for normal operation mdct
9.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
10. Insert the ECD records associated with the DCI using the error threshold (errthld)
form.
10.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the error_table: attribute.
Field Value
1. error_table dcierr
10.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate, screen#,
or Print:
11. Insert the ECD records associated with the DCI Display Process (DCIDIP) using the
user level automatic restart process (ularp) form.
11.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the rec_name: attribute.
Field Value
1. rec_name dcidip
11.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate, screen#,
or Print:
12. Insert the ECD records associated with the DCI using the logical device (logdev)
form.
NOTE:
One logdev record is required for diagnostics. Additional logdev records are
added as provided by application engineering.
12.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the logical_name: attribute.
Field Value
For diagnostic logdev form:
1. logical_name "/dgn/dcdx"
where x is the k_unit_number defined in the ucb form
5. dcn "9" to match the name of the driver as block device "j" (bdj)
6. driver_type "r" for diagnostic logdev form
For normal logdev forms:
1. logical_name begins with "dev"
2. partition set to logical channel number used for this logical device
12.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
The cursor moves to the logical_name: attribute.
13. Insert the ECD records associated with the DCI using the device definition (device)
form.
13.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the logical_devname:
attribute.
13.3. Populate all fields of the device form with information listed in Table 4-7
and as provided by application engineering.
Field Value
1. logical_devname DCDRVLOG
2. path /etc/log/DCDRVLOG
13.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
The cursor moves to the logical_devname:
attribute.
14. Insert the ECD records associated with the DCI using the class definition (classdef)
form.
NOTE:
The DCI driver uses class name 10 as the message class.
14.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the class_name: attribute.
14.3. Enter 10
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, or Print:
14.4. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
14.5. Enter 3
Response: The system displays row:
14.6. Enter a
Where: a = next available row.
14.10. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the class_name: attribute.
15.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
16. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821 [at Equipment Location (EQL)
28-060], remove CU 0 from service by operating the ROS/RST switch to the ROS
position.
NOTE:
Step 16 prevents automatic restoral of CU 0 when the unit is powered up later
in this procedure.
18. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), power down CU 0 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 0
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
19. Connect the DCI cable and install the Small Computer System Interface (SCSI) Bus
(SBUS) card for CU 0.
19.2. Install the DCI board in the SBUS slot as specified on the SPARCstation.
Installation procedures for installing SBUS cards are provided in the
Desktop SPARC Hardware Owner’s Guide.
19.3. Connect the end of the DCI cable to the Sun SPARCstation.
NOTE:
For assistance in mounting and grounding the DSCH cables, refer
to Figure 4-1.
Figure 4-1. DSCH Cables Grounding and Mounting for DCI Feature
20.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
21. Determine the PLU status by referring to the ROP output obtained in Step 4. If the
growth DCI is the first device under this channel, continue to Step 22; otherwise, go
to Step 23.
22. Update the DSCH down pointer and the DCI up pointer linkages.
22.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
22.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
22.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
22.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
22.6. Enter a
Where: a = channel number to which the DCI is being grown.
22.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
22.8. Enter 36
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_name:
attribute.
22.9. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_number:
attribute.
22.10. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
22.12. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DCI.
22.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
22.18. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DCI.
22.19. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
22.20. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
22.21. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_number:
attribute.
22.22. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
22.23. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
22.24. Enter a
Where: a = channel number to which the DCI is grown.
22.26. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
23.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
24. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), restore power to CU 0 by pressing the
START/ON/OFF switch to the ON position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED CU 0
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
25.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the Common
Processor Display Page (CPDP).
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics pass and the CU has been marked
standby.
27.2. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
28. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), remove CU 1 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 28 prevents automatic restoral of CU 1 when the unit is powered up later
in this procedure.
30. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), power down CU 1 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
31. Connect the DCI cable and install the SBUS card for CU 1.
32.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
33. Determine the PLU status by referring to the ROP output obtained in Step 4. If the
growth DCI is the first device under this channel, continue to Step 34; otherwise, go
to Step 35.
34. Update the DSCH down pointer and the DCI up pointer linkages.
34.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
34.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
34.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
34.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
34.6. Enter a
Where: a = channel number to which the DCI is being grown.
34.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
34.8. Enter 36
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_name:
attribute.
34.9. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_number:
attribute.
34.10. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
34.12. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DCI.
34.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
34.18. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DCI.
34.19. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
34.20. Enter 51
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_name:
attribute.
34.21. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_number:
attribute.
34.22. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 unit_name:
attribute.
34.23. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
34.24. Enter a
Where: a = channel number to which the DCI is grown.
34.26. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
35.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
36. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), restore power to CU 1 by pressing the
START/ON/OFF switch to the ON position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED CU 1
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
37.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics pass and the CU has been marked
standby.
39. Determine the PLU status by referring to the ROP output obtained in Step 4. If the
DCI was not the first device under the specified channel, continue to Steps 40
through 45; otherwise, go to Step 46.
40. At the MTTY, remove the PLU from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:a=b;
If PDS, RMV:a b!
41.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
42.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
42.5. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
42.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
42.7. Enter 3
Response: The system displays Change Field:
NOTE:
Record the existing values as shown for each side attribute listed
on the ucb form. Save this information for future reference in this
procedure.
42.8. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
42.9. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
42.11. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
42.12. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DCI.
42.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
43.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DCI.
43.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
NOTE:
If the PLU already had side pointers, use the information recorded
in Step 42.7 and add side pointers. If not, go to Step 43.10.
43.6. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
43.7. Enter a
Where: a = unit name recorded from the update of the PLU.
43.8. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
43.9. Enter a
Where: a = unit number recorded from the update of the PLU.
43.10. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
43.11. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_number:
attribute.
43.12. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
43.13. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
43.14. Enter a
Where: a = channel number to which the DCI is grown.
43.15. Enter 51
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_name:
attribute.
43.16. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_number:
attribute.
43.17. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 unit_name:
attribute.
43.18. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 unit_number:
attribute.
43.19. Enter a
Where: a = channel number to which the DCI is grown.
43.21. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
44.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
45. At the MTTY, restore the PLU to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
46.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
47.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
47.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DCI.
47.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
47.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
47.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
48.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
49. At the MTTY, diagnose the DCI with CU 0 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:DCI=a;
If PDS, DGN:DCI a!
50.2. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
51. At the MTTY, diagnose the DCI with CU 1 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:DCI=a;
If PDS, DGN:DCI a!
52.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
53.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
53.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DCI.
53.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
53.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
53.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
54.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
55. At the MTTY, restore the DCI device by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:DCI=a;
If PDS, RST:DCI a!
56. At the MTTY, verify the configuration and ensure that the DCI device is restored and
is in the ACT state by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, OP:CFGSTAT:DATA, DCI=a;
If PDS, OP:CFGSTAT:DCI a!
58. Verify that page is up for the DCI Display Process (DCIDIP). At MTTY CPDP 100,
select 108
Response: The CPDP 108 shows the DCIs that were added.
59.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
61. Invoke the root database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVSG,DB="ROOT",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVSG,DB "ROOT",NREVIEW!
62.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
Update the sgen2 record to add a block device ‘‘j’’ (bdj) driver.
63.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the ksgen: attribute.
63.4. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
63.5. Enter 10
Response: The system displays row:
63.6. Enter a
Where: a = next available row.
63.10. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the ksgen2: attribute.
64.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
65. At the MTTY, build boot image by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, UPD:BLDBOOT:DATA, BOOTIMAGE="/appdmert";
If PDS, UPD:BLDBOOT:BOOTIMAGE "/appdmert"!
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
67. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
68. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
5
Contents
Introduction 5-1
Prerequisite Conditions 5-1
References 5-2
Procedure 5-2
5
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow a Disk File Controller (DFC) into a
3B21D computer system. If Scanner and Signal Distributor Points are not available (this
must be verified with application engineering), the Scanner and Signal Distributor Controller
(SCSDC) circuit pack must be grown before continuing with this procedure. Refer to
Chapter 17, ‘‘SCSDC Growth.’’
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing the ECD using either the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode
(Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the command
mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
NOTE:
The following subprocedure provides the Unit Control Block (UCB) linkage for
channel subdevices from which the DFC will be grown. If the growth DFC is not
the first device under the specified channel, the Previous Logical Unit (PLU) to
the DFC will have to be removed in Step 17 in order to update the side pointer
linkages to bypass the DFC device.
3.3. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
3.4. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
3.5. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
3.6. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
3.7. Enter aa
Where: aa = channel number from which the DFC will be grown
as provided by application engineering.
3.8. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
4. At the MTTY, request hard copies of the forms from the ROP by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
5.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
6. Insert the unit control block (ucb) record associated with the DFC. The Real-Time
Reliable (RTR) convention for DFC/Small Computer System Interface (SCSI) Bus
(SBUS) number assignment is shown in Table 5-1.
SBUS Number
Assignment 1st 2nd
DFC 2 4 6
DFC 3 5 7
6.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
6.3. Populate all fields of the ucb form except fields 36 (down), 41 (side),
46 (cntrl_0), and 51 (cntrl_1). The fields in Table 5-2 contain default
values for fields that are static. Tables 5-3 and 5-4 contain the values
for fields 27 and 66 depending on the DFC pack code being grown. All
other field values must be as provided by application engineering.
Field Value
3. unit name "DFC"
4. unit number 2 or 3
5. essential "n"
6. top "n"
7. unique_unit "n"
8. pseudo_node "n"
9. restorable "n"
10. removable "n"
11. device_port DFC
12. device_type DFC
15. critical "y"
16. portswitch "n"
17. posswitch "0"
30. pathname pu/dfc
56. error_table dfcerr
6.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
7. Insert the ucb record associated with the DFC using the minor device chain table
(mdct) form.
7.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
7.3. Populate all fields of the mdct form. Default field values are described
in Table 5-5. Other field values must be as provided by application
engineering.
Field Value
7.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
8. Insert the ucb record associated with the DFC using the ucb form for the first
SBUS.
INSERT ucb RECORD ASSOCIATED WITH DFC USING ucb FORM FOR
FIRST SBUS PROCEDURE:
8.1. At the RC/V terminal, enter ucb
Response: The system displays Enter Database Operation
I=Insert R=Review U=Update D=Delete:
8.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
8.3. Populate all fields of the ucb form except fields 36 (down), 41 (side),
46 (cntrl_0), and 51 (cntrl_1). The fields in Table 5-6 contain default
values for fields that are static and apply to both SBUS records. Tables
5-7 and 5-8 contain the values for fields 27 and 66 depending on the
DFC pack code being grown. All other field values must be as provided
by application engineering.
Table 5-6. Default ucb Form Field Values for First and Second SBUS
Field Value
3. unit name "SBUS"
4. unit number Refer to Table 5-1.
5. essential "n"
6. top "n"
7. unique_unit "n"
8. pseudo_node "n"
9. restorable "n"
10. removable "n"
11. device_port DFC
12. device_type SBUS
15. critical "y"
16. portswitch "n"
17. posswitch "0"
30. pathname pu/sbus
56. error_table dfcerr
8.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
9. Insert the ucb record associated with the DFC using the ucb form for the second
SBUS.
INSERT ucb RECORD ASSOCIATED WITH DFC USING ucb FORM FOR
SECOND SBUS PROCEDURE:
9.1. At the RC/V terminal, enter ucb
Response: The system displays Enter Database Operation
I=Insert R=Review U=Update D=Delete:
9.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
9.3. Populate all fields of the ucb form except fields 36 (down), 41 (side),
46 (cntrl_0), and 51 (cntrl_1). The fields in Table 5-6 contain default
values for fields that are static and apply to both SBUS records.
Tables 5-7 and 5-8 contain the values for fields 27 and 66 depending on
the DFC pack codes being grown. All other field values must be as
provided by application engineering.
9.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
10. Insert the scanner and signal distributor option block body (scsdbody) record
associated with the DFC using the scsdbody form.
10.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
10.3. Populate all fields of the scsdbody form. Field values must be as
provided by application engineering.
10.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
11.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
12. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821, [at Equipment Location
(EQL) 28-060], operate the ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
Response: The system displays RMV CU 0 COMPLETED
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then to extinguish before continuing to
Step 13.
14. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove power from CU 0 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED
CU 0
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
Table 5-9. Circuit Pack and Power Circuit EQLs for DFC Growth
15.2. Connect the DSCH cable between the unavailable (CU 0) DSCH and the
growth SCSI DFC.
16. Refer to the ROP output obtained in Step 4 to determine where on the the channel
the DFC will be grown and if other units already exist under that channel.
If the growth DFC is the first device under the channel and no other devices
exist under the channel, then continue to Step 17 and then go to Step 19.
If the growth DFC is not the first device under the channel or if other devices
exist under the channel, then go to Step 18 and then continue to Step 19.
! CAUTION:
Do not grow a DFC as the first logical device under a DSCH if any other
devices (IOPs or DFCs) already exist under that channel.
17. Update the UCB linkages for the growth DFC when DFC is the first logical unit.
17.1.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
17.2. Update the growth DFC cntrl_0 pointer and down pointer linkage.
17.2.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
17.2.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DFC being grown.
17.2.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.2.8. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
17.2.9. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0
complex_number: attribute.
17.2.10. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
17.2.11. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
17.2.12. Enter aa
Where: aa = channel number from which the DFC is being
grown.
17.2.13. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
17.2.15. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_number:
attribute.
17.2.16. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the first SBUS controlled by the
growth DFC. Refer to Table 5-1 for SBUS number
assignments.
17.2.18. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.3.2. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
17.3.3. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number:
attribute.
17.3.4. Enter aa
Where: aa = channel number onto which the DFC is being
grown.
17.3.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.3.6. Enter 36
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_name:
attribute.
17.3.7. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down
complex_number: attribute.
17.3.8. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
17.3.10. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DFC being grown.
17.3.12. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.4. Update the first SBUS up pointer and side pointer linkages.
17.4.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the first SBUS controlled by the
growth DFC.
17.4.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.4.6. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
17.4.7. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0
complex_number: attribute.
17.4.8. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
17.4.10. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DFC.
17.4.11. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
17.4.13. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
17.4.14. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the first SBUS controlled by the
growth DFC. Refer to Table 5-1 for SBUS number
assignments.
17.4.16. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.5.4. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the second SBUS controlled by the
growth DFC. Refer to Table 5-1 for SBUS number
assignments.
17.5.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.5.6. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
17.5.7. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0
complex_number: attribute.
17.5.8. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
17.5.10. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DFC.
17.5.12. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.6.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
17.7. Update the ECD linkages for DFC as an added unit to the channel.
NOTE:
Refer to the ROP output obtained in Step 4 to determine the
PLU.
17.8.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
17.9.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name:
attribute.
17.9.5. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
17.9.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
17.9.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.9.8. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
17.9.10. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
17.9.11. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DFC being grown.
17.9.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.10. Update the growth DFC cntrl_0 pointer and down pointer linkage.
17.10.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DFC being grown.
17.10.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.10.6. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
17.10.7. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0
complex_number: attribute.
17.10.8. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
17.10.9. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
17.10.10. Enter aa
Where: aa = channel number onto which the DFC is being
grown.
17.10.11. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
17.10.13. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_number:
attribute.
17.10.14. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the first SBUS controlled by the
growth DFC. Refer to Table 5-1 for SBUS number
assignments.
17.10.16. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.11. Update the first SBUS up pointer and side pointer linkage.
17.11.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the first SBUS controlled by the
growth DFC.
17.11.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.11.6. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
17.11.7. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0
complex_number: attribute.
17.11.8. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
17.11.10. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DFC.
17.11.11. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
17.11.13. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
17.11.14. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the second SBUS controlled by the
growth DFC. Refer to Table 5-1 for SBUS number
assignments.
17.11.16. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.12.4. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the second SBUS controlled by the
growth DFC.
17.12.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.12.6. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
17.12.7. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0
complex_number: attribute.
17.12.8. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
17.12.10. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth DFC.
17.12.12. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.13.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
18. At the MTTY, restore the PLU to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
19.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the Common
Processor Display Page (CPDP).
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then to extinguish before
continuing to Step 20.2.
20.3. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 0 in progress and wait until CU 0 is restored to standby before
continuing.
21.2. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
22. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), remove CU 1 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 22 prevents automatic restoral of CU 1 when the unit is powered up later
in this procedure.
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then to extinguish before
continuing to Step 24.
24. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), power down CU 1 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
25. Connect the DSCH cable for CU 1. Connect the DSCH cable between the
unavailable (off-line) DSCH and the growth SCSI DFC. Refer to Tables 5-10 and
5-11.
DSCH Location
Channel Subdevice EQL Terminal Assign To Notes
0 28-075 351 IOP 0 1,2,3
1 & 345 IOP 2
11
2 338 DFC 0
53-075
3 332 3B21D computer (reserved)
0 28-075 151 2,3,4
1 & 145
12
2 138
53-075
3 132 spare
0 28-075 319 IOP 1 1,2,3
1 & 313 IOP 3
13
2 300 DFC 1
53-075
3 300 3B21D computer (reserved)
0 28-075 119 2,3,4
1 & 116
14
2 106
53-075
3 100 spare
Notes:
1. Fixed assignment reserved by UNIX Real-Time Reliable (RTR).
2. Equipment Location (EQL) 28-075 corresponds to Control Unit (CU) 0.
3. EQL 53-075 corresponds to CU 1.
4. All other slots not assigned to UNIX RTR are available for other applications.
3. Table includes both Direct Memory Access (DMA) 0 and 1.
DSCH Location
Channel Subdevice EQL Terminal Notes
0 28-065 351 1,2
1 & 345 1,2
16
2 338
53-065
3 332
0 28-065 151 1,2
1 & 145
17
2 138
53-065
3 132
0 28-065 319 1,2
1 & 313
18
2 306 1,2
53-065
3 300
0 28-065 119 1,2
1 & 113
19
2 106
53-065
3 100
Notes:
1. Equipment Location (EQL) 28-065 corresponds to Control Unit (CU) 0.
2. EQL 53-065 corresponds to CU 1.
3. Table includes both Direct Memory Access (DMA) 0 and 1.
26.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
27.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
27.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DFC being grown.
27.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
27.8. Enter 51
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_name:
attribute.
27.9. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 complex_number:
attribute.
27.10. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 unit_name:
attribute.
27.11. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_1 unit_number:
attribute.
27.12. Enter aa
Where: aa = channel number from which the DFC is being grown.
27.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
28.2. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
28.3. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
28.4. Enter aa
Where: aa = channel number onto which the DFC is being grown.
28.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
28.6. Enter 36
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_name:
attribute.
28.7. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down complex_number:
attribute.
28.8. Enter ’
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
28.10. Enter a
Where: aa = unit number of the DFC being grown.
28.12. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
29.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
30.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then to extinguish before
continuing to Step 31.2.
31.3. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 1 in progress and wait until CU 1 is restored to standby before
continuing.
32.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
33.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
33.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DFC being grown.
33.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
33.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
33.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
34.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
34.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the SBUS being grown.
34.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
34.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
34.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
35.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
35.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the SBUS being grown.
35.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
35.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
35.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
36.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
37. At the MTTY, restart the Disk File System Access (DFSA) page by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, STOP:EXC:DATA,ANY,FN="/cft/dap/dkdip ",UCL;
If PDS, STOP:EXC:ANY,FN"/cft/dap/dkdip ",UCL!
38. At the MTTY, remove the IOP from service that controls the SCSDC to which the
growth DFC will be connected by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=a;
If PDS, RMV:IOP a!
39. At Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS) TN1820, remove power from
IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
40. Connect the SCSD cable from the growth DFC to the SCSDC.
41. At IOPPS TN1820 for IOP a, restore power to IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
NOTE 1:
The OFF LED at IOP a IOPPS TN1820 extinguishes.
NOTE 2:
The IOP and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching the
CPDP.
42. At the MTTY, restore IOP 1 to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:IOP=a;
If PDS, RST:IOP a!
43. At the MTTY, diagnose the DFC with CU 0 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:DFC=a;
If PDS, DGN:DFC a!
44.2. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
45. At the MTTY, diagnose the DFC with CU 1 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:DFC=a;
If PDS, DGN:DFC a!
46.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
47.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
47.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DFC being grown.
47.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
47.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
47.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
48.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
48.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the first SBUS being grown.
48.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
48.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
48.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
49.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
49.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the second SBUS being grown.
49.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
49.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
50.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
51. At the MTTY, restore the DFC unit by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:DFC=a;
If PDS, RST:DFC a!
NOTE:
Wait until this command completes before continuing to Step 52.
52. At the MTTY, verify configuration and that the DFC device is restored and is active
by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, OP:CFGSTAT:DATA, DFC=a;
If PDS, OP:CFGSTAT:DFC a!
53.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
55. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
56. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
NOTE:
Proceed to the SCSI growth chapters (Chapters 11 and 20) as required to add drives
or other peripherals.
6
Contents
Introduction 6-1
Prerequisite Conditions 6-1
References 6-2
DMA Assignments 6-2
Procedure 6-4
6
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow a Direct Memory Access Controller
(DMAC)/Dual Serial Channel (DSCH) circuit pack (KBN15) into a 3B21D computer system.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist before starting this growth procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 24 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
DMA Assignments
Table 6-1 describes the Direct Memory Access (DMA) 0 DSCH assignments for the 3B21D
computer. Table 6-2 describes the DMA 1 assignments.
DSCH Location
Channel Subdevice EQL Terminal Assign To Notes
0 28-075 351 IOP 0 1,2,3
1 & 345 IOP 2
11
2 338 DFC 0
53-075
3 332 3B21D computer (reserved)
0 28-075 151 2,3,4
1 & 145
12
2 138
53-075
3 132 spare
0 28-075 319 IOP 1 1,2,3
1 & 313 IOP 3
13
2 300 DFC 1
53-075
3 300 3B21D computer (reserved)
0 28-075 119 2,3,4
1 & 116
14
2 106
53-075
3 100 spare
Notes:
1. Fixed assignment reserved by UNIX Real-Time Reliable (RTR).
2. Equipment Location (EQL) 28-075 corresponds to Control Unit (CU) 0.
3. EQL 53-075 corresponds to CU 1.
4. All other slots not assigned to UNIX RTR are available for other
applications.
5. Table includes both Direct Memory Access (DMA) 0 and DMA 1.
DSCH Location
Channel Subdevice EQL Terminal Notes
0 28-065 351 1,2
1 & 345 1,2
16
2 338
53-065
3 332
0 28-065 151 1,2
1 & 145
17
2 138
53-065
3 132
0 28-065 319 1,2
1 & 313
18
2 306 1,2
53-065
3 300
0 28-065 119 1,2
1 & 113
19
2 106
53-065
3 100
Notes:
1. Equipment Location (EQL) 28-065 corresponds to Control Unit (CU) 0.
2. EQL 53-065 corresponds to CU 1.
3. Table includes both Direct Memory Access (DMA) 0 and DMA 1.
Procedure
1. At the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY), verify and set the initial conditions.
NOTE 1:
Evaluate the system response to determine if system status is
acceptable to continue. Correct any deficiency as required.
NOTE 2:
Automatic maintenance requests are inhibited. They must be
allowed at the conclusion of this procedure.
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will
periodically appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
The existing DMA/DSCH forms in the current system should be printed and
used for reference during this subprocedure. The printout is useful if backout
subprocedures must be performed. Another useful reference is the link list of
Unit Control Block (UCB) pointers which is printed via the database information
(dbinfo) form.
2.1. Determine whether the MTTY or the Recent Change and Verify (RC/V)
terminal is to be used.
If the MTTY, continue to Step 2.2.
If the RC/V terminal, go to Step 2.5.
2.2. At the MTTY, ensure that the terminal is in the command mode.
2.3. Enter menu command 199
Response: The system displays the RCV ECD Parameter Info
form.
The cursor moves to the database_name: attribute.
2.7. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.10. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.12. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
2.13. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
2.15. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.16. Enter p
Response: The system flashes Form Printed: in the upper
right corner of the screen and then displays Enter
Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.18. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
2.19. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
2.21. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.22. Enter p
Response: The system flashes Form Printed: in the upper
right corner of the screen and then displays Enter
Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.24. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
2.25. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
2.26. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
2.27. Enter 12
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.28. Enter p
Response: The system flashes Form Printed: in the upper
right corner of the screen and then displays Enter
Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.30. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
2.31. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
2.32. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
2.33. Enter 12
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.34. Enter p
Response: The system flashes Form Printed: in the upper
right corner of the screen and then displays Enter
Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.36. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
2.37. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
2.38. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
2.39. Enter 14
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.40. Enter p
Response: The system flashes Form Printed: in the upper
right corner of the screen and then displays Enter
Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.42. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
2.43. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
2.44. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
2.45. Enter 14
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.46. Enter p
Response: The system flashes Form Printed: in the upper
right corner of the screen and then displays Enter
Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.51. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
2.52. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
2.53. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
2.54. Enter CC
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
2.55. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the iop_list: attribute.
2.56. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Enter Review, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
2.57. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.60. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
2.61. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
2.62. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
2.63. Enter CC
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
2.64. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the iop_list: attribute.
2.65. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Enter Review, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
2.66. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
3.3. At the MTTY, ensure that the terminal is in the command mode.
3.4. Enter menu command 199
Response: The system displays the RCV ECD Parameter Info
form.
The cursor moves to the database_name: attribute.
3.5. Go to Step 3.7.
3.6. At the RC/V terminal, enter the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD!
3.8. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
3.9. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
3.10. Verify that DMA 1 ucb forms are in the database as unequipped.
NOTE:
Review the dbinfo ucb list obtained in Step 2.68.
NOTE:
If the forms exist, they are set up the way the application
intended them to be, unequipped and disconnected.
3.13. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
4.2. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
4.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
4.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
4.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
4.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.8. Enter 4
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
4.9. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.10. Enter 13
Response: The cursor moves to the internal_device: attribute.
4.11. Enter 15
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.12. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
4.14. Enter 24
Response: The cursor moves to the channel_num: attribute.
4.15. Enter 15
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.16. Enter 37
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
4.17. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.18. Enter 38
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
4.19. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.20. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
4.21. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.22. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
4.23. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.24. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
4.25. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.26. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
4.27. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.28. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
4.29. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.30. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
4.31. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.32. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
4.33. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.34. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
4.35. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.37. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
5.2. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
5.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
5.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
5.6. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
5.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
5.8. Enter 2
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
5.9. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
5.11. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
6.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
7. Verify that the ucb forms for CU 0 (channels 16 through 19) are in the database as
unequipped.
NOTE:
Review the dbinfo ucb list obtained in Step 2.68.
NOTE:
If the forms exist, check the form and record interrupt_num (No. 28).
NOTE:
If forms are added in these steps, the interrupt_num (No. 28) will be
interrupt source 10.
8.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
9.2. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
9.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
9.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
9.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
9.6. Enter 11
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
9.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.8. Enter 4
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
9.9. Enter 16
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.10. Enter 13
Response: The cursor moves to the internal_device: attribute.
9.11. Enter 16
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.12. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
9.14. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
9.16. Enter 24
Response: The cursor moves to the channel_num: attribute.
9.17. Enter 16
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.18. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
9.19. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.20. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
9.21. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.22. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
9.23. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.24. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
9.25. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.26. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
9.27. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.28. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
9.29. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.30. Enter 47
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
9.31. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.32. Enter 48
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
9.33. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.34. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
9.35. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.36. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
9.37. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.39. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
9.42. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
9.43. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
9.44. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
9.45. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
9.46. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
9.47. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.48. Enter 4
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
9.49. Enter 17
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.50. Enter 13
Response: The cursor moves to the internal_device: attribute.
9.51. Enter 17
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.52. Enter 24
Response: The cursor moves to the channel_num: attribute.
9.53. Enter 17
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.55. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
9.58. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
9.59. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
9.60. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
9.61. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
9.62. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
9.63. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.64. Enter 4
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
9.65. Enter 18
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.66. Enter 13
Response: The cursor moves to the internal_device: attribute.
9.67. Enter 18
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.68. Enter 24
Response: The cursor moves to the channel_num: attribute.
9.69. Enter 18
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.71. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
9.74. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
9.75. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
9.76. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
9.77. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
9.78. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
9.79. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.80. Enter 4
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
9.81. Enter 19
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.82. Enter 13
Response: The cursor moves to the internal_device: attribute.
9.83. Enter 19
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.84. Enter 24
Response: The cursor moves to the channel_num: attribute.
9.85. Enter 19
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.87. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
10.2. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
10.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
10.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
10.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
10.6. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
10.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.8. Enter 2
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
10.9. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.11. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
10.12. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.13. Enter 4
Response: The system displays the ucb form for channel 16.
The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
10.14. Enter 17
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.15. Enter 13
Response: The cursor moves to the internal_device: attribute.
10.16. Enter 17
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.17. Enter 24
Response: The cursor moves to the channel_num: attribute.
10.18. Enter 17
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.20. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
10.21. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.22. Enter 4
Response: The system displays the ucb form for channel 16.
The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
10.23. Enter 18
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.24. Enter 13
Response: The cursor moves to the internal_device: attribute.
10.25. Enter 18
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.26. Enter 24
Response: The cursor moves to the channel_num: attribute.
10.27. Enter 18
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.29. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
10.30. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.31. Enter 4
Response: The system displays the ucb form for channel 16.
The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
10.32. Enter 19
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.33. Enter 13
Response: The cursor moves to the internal_device: attribute.
10.34. Enter 19
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.35. Enter 24
Response: The cursor moves to the channel_num: attribute.
10.36. Enter 19
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.38. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
11.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
The following subprocedure assumes CU 0 is on standby. If necessary, at the
MTTY, execute a switch to achieve this configuration by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
14.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
15. Update the side pointers of the Previous Logical Unit (PLU) to the growth DMA.
15.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
15.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
15.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
15.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
15.7. Enter 3
Response: The system displays page 3 of the ucb form with
choices.
NOTE:
Record the values as shown for each side attribute listed on the
ucb form. Save this information for later reference in this
procedure.
15.8. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.9. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
15.10. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.11. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
15.12. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.13. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
15.15. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
15.16. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.18. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
16.2. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
16.4. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
16.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
NOTE:
If the PLU to DMA 1 already had side pointers, use the information
recorded in Step 15.7 and change side pointers. If there are no
side pointers, go to Step 16.10.
16.6. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
16.7. Enter the unit name recorded from the update of the PLU.
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.8. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
16.9. Enter the unit number recorded from the update of the PLU.
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.10. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
16.11. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.12. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
16.13. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.14. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
16.17. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
17.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
18. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821 [at Equipment Location
(EQL) 28-060], remove power from OOS CU 0 by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch
to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 0 followed
by REPT CU 0 UNAVAILABLE
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
19. Insert the DMAC/DSCH circuit pack (KBN15) and 410AA power supply for CU 0.
NOTE 1:
If the ucb forms existed, check the interrupt_num (No. 28).
NOTE 2:
If the ucb forms are added during this procedure, their interrupt_num (No. 28)
would be interrupt source 10.
20. If the interrupt_num wires are in place, verify connections are correct based on the
following or add interrupt_num wires as follows:
If interrupt_num
Channel Is: Wire from Terminal Wire to Terminal
* 028-037-050 028-037-049
16, 17, 18, and 19 10 028-037-049 028-038-049T
11 028-037-049 028-038-048T
* If interrupt_num is the same for all channels (16, 17, 18, and 19).
21. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), restore power to CU 0 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
22. At the MTTY, diagnose CU 0 DMA 1 by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, DGN:CU=0,DMA=1;
If PDS, DGN:CU 0,DMA 1!
NOTE:
An ATP condition must be achieved before continuing.
23.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
24.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
24.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
24.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
24.6. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
24.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
24.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
24.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
25.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
26.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics pass and the CU has been
marked standby.
28.3. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
29. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove CU 1 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 29 prevents automatic restoral of the CU 1 when the unit is powered up in
this procedure.
31.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
32. Update the side pointers of the PLU to the growth DMA.
32.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
32.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
32.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
32.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
32.7. Enter 3
Response: The system displays page 3 of the ucb form with
choices.
NOTE:
Record the values as shown for each side attribute listed on the
ucb form. Save this information for later reference in this
procedure.
32.8. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
32.9. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
32.10. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
32.11. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
32.12. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
32.13. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
32.15. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
32.16. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
32.18. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
33.2. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
33.4. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
33.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
NOTE:
If the PLU to DMA 1 has side pointers, use information recorded in
Step 32.7 and change side pointers. If there are no side pointers,
go to Step 33.10.
33.6. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
33.7. Enter the unit name recorded from the update of the PLU.
Response: The system displays Change Field:
33.8. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
33.9. Enter the unit name recorded from the update of the PLU.
Response: The system displays Change Field:
33.10. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
33.11. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
33.12. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
33.13. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
33.14. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
33.17. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
34.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
35. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), remove power from the OOS CU 1 by operating
the ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1 followed
by REPT CU 1 UNAVAILABLE
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
36. Insert the DMAC/DSCH circuit pack (KBN15) and 410AA power supply for CU 1.
NOTE 1:
If the ucb forms already existed, check the interrupt_num (No. 28).
NOTE 2:
If the ucb forms are added during this procedure, their interrupt_num (No. 28)
would be interrupt source 10.
37. If interrupt_num wires are in place, verify connections are correct based on the
following or add interrupt_num wires as follows:
If interrupt_num
Channel Is: Wire from Terminal Wire to Terminal
* 053-037-050 053-037-049
16, 17, 18, and 19 10 053-037-049 053-038-049T
11 053-037-049 053-038-048T
* If interrupt_num is the same for all channels (16, 17, 18, and 19).
38. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), restore power to CU 1 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
39. At the MTTY, diagnose CU 1 DMA 1 by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, DGN:CU=1,DMA=1;
If PDS, DGN:CU 1,DMA 1!
NOTE:
An ATP condition must be achieved before continuing.
40.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
41.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
41.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
41.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
41.6. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
41.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
41.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
41.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
42.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
43.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics pass and the CU has been
marked standby.
45.3. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
NOTE:
The following subprocedure assumes CU 0 is on standby. If necessary, at the
MTTY, execute a switch to achieve this configuration by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
48.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
49. Update the DSCH side pointer linkages, controller linkages, and major status for
CU 0.
49.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
49.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
49.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
49.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
49.6. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
49.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.8. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
49.9. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.10. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
49.11. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.12. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
49.13. Enter CH
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.14. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
49.15. Enter 17
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.16. Enter 47
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
49.17. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.18. Enter 48
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
49.19. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.20. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
49.22. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
49.23. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.24. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
49.26. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
49.29. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
49.30. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
49.31. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
49.32. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
49.33. Enter 17
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
49.34. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.35. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
49.36. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.37. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
49.38. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.39. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
49.40. Enter CH
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.41. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
49.42. Enter 18
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.43. Enter 47
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
49.44. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.45. Enter 48
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
49.46. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.47. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
49.49. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
49.50. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.51. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
49.53. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
49.56. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
49.57. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
49.58. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
49.59. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
49.60. Enter 18
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
49.61. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.62. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
49.63. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.64. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
49.65. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.66. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
49.67. Enter CH
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.68. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
49.69. Enter 19
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.70. Enter 47
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
49.71. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.72. Enter 48
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
49.73. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.74. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
49.76. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
49.77. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.78. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
49.80. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
49.83. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
49.84. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
49.85. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
49.86. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
49.87. Enter 19
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
49.88. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.89. Enter 47
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
49.90. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.91. Enter 48
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
49.92. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.93. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
49.95. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
49.96. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
49.97. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
49.99. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
49.102. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
50. Update the growth DMA down pointer linkage to the growth DSCH for CU 0, DMA 1.
50.2. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
50.4. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
50.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
50.6. Enter 37
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
50.7. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
50.8. Enter 38
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
50.9. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
50.10. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
50.11. Enter CH
Response: The system displays Change Field:
50.12. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
50.13. Enter 16
Response: The system displays Change Field:
50.15. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
51.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
52. At the MTTY, diagnose CU 0 DSCH 16 by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, DGN:CU=0,CH=16:RAW,TLP;
If PDS, DGN:CU 0,CH 16:RAW,TLP!
NOTE:
A Conditional All Tests Passed (CATP) result must be achieved before
continuing. Repeat Step 52 for DSCH 17, 18, and 19.
53.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
54. Update the growth DSCH status from GROW to OOS for CU 0.
54.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
54.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
54.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
54.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
54.6. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
54.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
54.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
54.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
54.12. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
54.13. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
54.14. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
54.15. Enter 17
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
54.16. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
54.17. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
54.20. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
54.21. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
54.22. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
54.23. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
54.24. Enter 18
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
54.25. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
54.26. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
54.29. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
54.30. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
54.31. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
54.32. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
54.33. Enter 19
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
54.34. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
54.35. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
54.38. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
55.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics pass and the CU has been
marked standby.
58.2. At the MTTY, switch the CUs by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
58.3. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
NOTE:
The following subprocedure assumes CU 1 is on standby. If necessary, at the
MTTY, execute a switch to achieve this configuration by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
61.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
62. Update the DSCH side pointer linkages, controller linkages, and major status for
CU 1.
62.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
62.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
62.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
62.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
62.6. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
62.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.8. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
62.9. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.10. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
62.11. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.12. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
62.13. Enter CH
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.14. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
62.15. Enter 17
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.16. Enter 47
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
62.17. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.18. Enter 48
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
62.19. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.20. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
62.22. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
62.23. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.24. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
62.26. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
62.29. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
62.30. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
62.31. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
62.32. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
62.33. Enter 17
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
62.34. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.35. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
62.36. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.37. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
62.38. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.39. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
62.40. Enter CH
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.41. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
62.42. Enter 18
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.43. Enter 47
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
62.44. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.45. Enter 48
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
62.46. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.47. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
62.49. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
62.50. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.51. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
62.53. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
62.56. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
62.57. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
62.58. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
62.59. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
62.60. Enter 18
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
62.61. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.62. Enter 42
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
62.63. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.64. Enter 43
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
62.65. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.66. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
62.67. Enter CH
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.68. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
62.69. Enter 19
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.70. Enter 47
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
62.71. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.72. Enter 48
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
62.73. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.74. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
62.76. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
62.77. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.78. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
62.80. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
62.83. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
62.84. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
62.85. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
62.86. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
62.87. Enter 19
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
62.88. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.89. Enter 47
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
62.90. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.91. Enter 48
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
62.92. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.93. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
62.95. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
62.96. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
62.97. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
62.99. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
62.102. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
63. Update the growth DMA down pointer linkage to the growth DSCH for CU 1.
63.2. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
63.4. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
63.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
63.6. Enter 37
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
63.7. Enter CU
Response: The system displays Change Field:
63.8. Enter 38
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
63.9. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field:
63.10. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
63.11. Enter CH
Response: The system displays Change Field:
63.12. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
63.13. Enter 16
Response: The system displays Change Field:
63.15. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
64.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
65. At the MTTY, diagnose CU 1 DSCH 16 by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, DGN:CU=1,CH=16:RAW,TLP;
If PDS, DGN:CU 1,CH 16:RAW,TLP!
NOTE:
A CATP condition must be achieved before continuing. Repeat this step for
channels 17, 18, and 19.
66.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
67. Update the growth DSCH status from GROW to OOS for CU 1.
67.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
67.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
67.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
67.5. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
67.6. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
67.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
67.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
67.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
67.12. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
67.13. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
67.14. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
67.15. Enter 17
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
67.16. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
67.17. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
67.20. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
67.21. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
67.22. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
67.23. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
67.24. Enter 18
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
67.25. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
67.26. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
67.29. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
67.30. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
67.31. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
67.32. Enter CH
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
67.33. Enter 19
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
67.34. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
67.35. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
67.38. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
68.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics pass and the CU has been
marked standby.
71.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
73. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
74. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
7
Contents
Introduction 7-1
Prerequisite Conditions 7-1
References 7-2
Procedure 7-2
7
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow a High-Speed Data Link Controller
(HSDC) from a 3B21D computer system.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing ECD using either the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode
(Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
3. Determine the Previous Logical Unit (PLU) and the Next Logical Unit (NLU).
3.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP from which the HSDC will be
degrown.
NOTE:
The pc (in link order) attribute displays the Unit Control Block
(UCB) linkage for IOP a subdevices. If the HSDC is not the first
unit under the IOP (that is, there are other units under the IOP),
examine the unitname and unitnumber attributes under the
unitname and unitnumber columns and determine which unit is
the PLU and which unit is the NLU to the growth HSDC. It is
important to note that the PLU will be removed from service in Step
16. Note the unitname and unitnumber attributes for the PLU and
NLU. These values will be used in the following steps.
3.5. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
NOTE:
The following subprocedure provides the UCB linkage for channel subdevices
from which the Dual Serial Channel Computer Interconnect (DCI) will be
degrown. If the DCI to be removed is not the first device under the specified
channel, the PLU to the DCI will have to be removed in Step 14 in order to
update the side pointer linkages to bypass the DCI device. For use later in this
procedure, this subprocedure also provides the UCB pointer list which shows
the forms which must removed and the Minor Device Chain Table (MDCT)
pointer list which provides the logical device (logdev) records associated with
the DCI device being degrown.
4.5. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the form_type: attribute.
4.10. Enter aa
Where: aa = unit number of the HSDC being removed.
4.11. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
4.16. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the form_type: attribute.
4.19. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
5. At the MTTY, request hard copies from the ROP by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
6. At the MTTY, remove the HSDC from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:HSDC=a;
If PDS, RMV:HSDC a!
7.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
8.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
8.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the HSDC being degrown.
8.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
8.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
8.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
9.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
10.2. Verify that both port switches, located at the bottom of the processor
cabinet, are in the AUTO position and if not, operate switches to the
AUTO position.
10.3. At the MTTY, switch to another IOP by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW MTTY!
10.4. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the ROP is connected to the IOP from
which the HSDC is to be degrown.
If yes, continue to Step 10.5.
If no, go to Step 10.7.
10.5. Verify that both port switches, located at the bottom of the processor
cabinet, are in the AUTO position and if not, operate switches to the
AUTO position.
10.6. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to another IOP by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW ROP!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
11. At IOPPS TN1820, remove power from IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch
to the OFF position. Refer to Table 7-1 for IOPPS EQLs.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP a
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
13. At IOPPS TN1820, restore power to IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to
the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
NOTE 1:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED at IOP a extinguishes.
NOTE 2:
The IOP and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching
CPDP.
14. Determine if the degrowth HSDC is the first device under the IOP channel and if
other devices exist under the channel.
If the degrowth HSDC is the first device under the IOP channel, continue to
Step 15 and then go to Step 17.
If the degrowth HSDC is not the first device under the IOP channel, go to Step
16 and then continue to Step 17.
15. Update the ECD linkages for the degrowth HSDC when the HSDC is the first device
under the IOP channel.
15.1.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
15.2. Modify the IOP down pointers to bypass the degrowth HSDC.
15.2.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name:
attribute.
15.2.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
15.2.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.2.8. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
15.2.9. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that is,
the degrowth HSDC is at the end of the chain).
15.2.10. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_number:
attribute.
15.2.11. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that
is, the degrowth HSDC is at the end of the chain).
15.2.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
15.3.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the HSDC being degrown.
15.3.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.3.6. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
15.3.7. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.3.8. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
15.3.9. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.3.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
15.4.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
16. Update the ECD linkages for degrowth HSDC when the HSDC is not the first logical
unit under the IOP.
NOTE:
The PLU name and number were obtained in Step 3.
16.2.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
16.3.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name:
attribute.
16.3.5. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
16.3.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
16.3.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.3.8. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
16.3.9. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that is,
the degrowth HSDC is at the end of the chain).
16.3.10. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
16.3.11. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that
is, the degrowth HSDC is at the end of the chain).
16.3.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
16.4.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the degrowth HSDC.
16.4.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.6. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
16.4.7. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.8. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
16.4.9. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.10. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
16.4.11. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.12. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
16.4.13. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.15. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
16.5.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
16.6. At the MTTY, restore the PLU to service by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
NOTE:
The PLU name and number were obtained in Step 3.
17.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
18.1.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
18.1.3. Enter the mdct record name of the HSDC being degrown.
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form
and displays Enter Delete, Validate, screen#, or
Print:
18.1.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
18.2.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
18.2.3. Enter the ucb record name of the HSDC being degrown.
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form
and displays Enter Delete, Validate, screen#, or
Print:
18.2.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... FORM DELETED
followed by Enter Review, Change-insert,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
19.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
20.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
22. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
23. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
8
Contents
Introduction 8-1
Prerequisite Conditions 8-1
References 8-2
Procedure 8-2
8
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow a High-Speed Data Link Controller
(HSDC) into a 3B21D computer system.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
Procedure
The following steps describe the HSDC growth procedure:
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing ECD using either the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode
(Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the command
mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
3. Determine the Previous Logical Unit (PLU) and the Next Logical Unit (NLU).
3.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP onto which the HSDC will be
grown.
NOTE:
The pc (in link order) attribute displays the Unit Control Block
(UCB) linkage for IOP a subdevices. If the HSDC is not the first
unit under the IOP (that is, there are other units under the IOP),
examine the unitname and unitnumber attributes under the
unitname and unitnumber columns and determine which unit is
the PLU and which unit is the NLU to the growth HSDC. It is
important to note that the PLU will be removed from service in Step
13. Note the unitname and unitnumber attributes for the PLU and
NLU. These values will be used in the following steps.
3.5. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
4.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
5.1.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
5.1.3. Populate all fields of the ucb form except fields 36 (down), 41 (side),
46 (cntrl_0), and 51 (cntrl_1). The fields in Table 8-1 contain default
values for fields that are static. All other field values must be as
provided by application engineering.
Field Value
11. device_port IOP
12. device_type HSDC
30. pathname pu/duic
56. error_table ioperr
66. u_model 5
5.1.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM
INSERTED followed by Enter Review, Change-
insert, Validate, screen#, or Print:
5.2.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
5.2.3. Populate all fields of the mdct form. Static field values are described
in Table 8-2. Other field values must be as provided by application
engineering.
Field Value
2. logical_device io
3. mdct_type l
5.2.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM
INSERTED
The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
6.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
7.2. Verify that the port switches, located at the bottom of the processor
cabinet, are both in the AUTO position.
7.3. At the MTTY, switch the MTTY to another IOP by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW MTTY!
7.4. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify the ROP is connected to the IOP on which
the HSDC is to be grown.
If yes, continue to Step 7.5.
If no, go to Step 7.7.
7.5. Verify that the port switches, located at the bottom of the processor
cabinet, are both in the AUTO position.
7.6. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to another IOP by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW ROP!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
8. At IOPPS TN1820, remove power from IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch
to the OFF position. Refer to Table 8-3 for IOPPS Equipment Locations (EQLs).
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
10. At IOPPS TN1820, restore power to IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to
the ST position and releasing to the ON position. Refer to Table 8-3 for IOPPS
EQLs.
NOTE 1:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED at IOP a extinguishes.
NOTE 2:
The IOP and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching
the CPDP.
11. Determine if the growth HSDC is the first device under the IOP channel and if other
devices exist under the channel.
If the growth HSDC is the first device under the IOP channel, continue to Step
12 and then go to Step 14.
If the growth HSDC is not the first device under the IOP channel, go to
Step 13 and then continue to Step 14.
12. Update the ECD linkages for the growth HSDC when the HSDC is the first logical
unit.
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
12.2.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
12.3.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name:
attribute.
12.3.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
12.3.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
12.3.8. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
12.3.10. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_number:
attribute.
12.3.11. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the HSDC.
12.3.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
12.4. Update the HSDC cntrl pointers and major status to GROW.
12.4.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the HSDC being grown.
12.4.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
12.4.6. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
12.4.8. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
12.4.9. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
12.4.10. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
12.4.11. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
12.4.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
12.5.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
The system displays REPT HSDC a in growth
state followed by REPT HSDC a growth in
process followed by REPT HSDC a COMPLETED
12.6. At the MTTY, restore the IOP to service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RST:IOP=a;
If PDS, RST:IOP a!
NOTE:
Wait for all subunits of the IOP to restore before continuing.
13. Update the ECD linkages for the growth HSDC as an added unit to the IOP.
NOTE:
The PLU name and number were obtained in Step 3.
13.2.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
13.3.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name:
attribute.
13.3.5. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
13.3.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the PLU.
13.3.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
13.3.8. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
13.3.10. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
13.3.11. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the growth HSDC.
13.3.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
13.4. Update the HSDC side and cntrl pointers and major status to GROW.
13.4.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth HSDC.
13.4.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
13.4.6. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
13.4.7. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that is,
the growth HSDC is at the end of the chain).
13.4.8. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
13.4.9. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that
is, the growth HSDC is at the end of the chain).
13.4.10. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
13.4.12. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
13.4.13. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
13.4.14. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
13.4.17. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
13.5.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
13.6. At the MTTY, restore the PLU to service by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
NOTE:
The PLU name and number were obtained in Step 3.
14. At the MTTY, diagnose the growth HSDC by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:HSDC=a,RAW,TLP;
If PDS, DGN:HSDC a,RAW,TLP!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
15.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
16.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
16.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the HSDC being grown.
16.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
16.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
18. At the MTTY, restore the HSDC by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:HSDC=a;
If PDS, RST:HSDC a!
19.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
20. Update the ECD for rootdmly by repeating Steps 5 through 9 and Steps 18 through
22 using rootdmly instead of incore when preparing the ECD RC/V terminal, then go
to Step 6.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
22. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
23. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
9
Contents
Introduction 9-1
Prerequisite Conditions 9-1
References 9-2
Procedure 9-2
9
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow an Input/Output Processor (IOP 2 or
IOP 3) from a 3B21D computer system.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), IOPs, Moving Head Disks (MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-105, Hardware Reference Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
1. Invoke the incore database high-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing the ECD using either the menu mode (Step 1.1) or the command mode
(Step 1.2).
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.1.5. Go to Step 2.
1.2. Invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the command
mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2.3. Enter y
2.6. Enter CU
2.7. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of CU 0 or CU 1.
NOTE:
This procedure provides the UCB pointer linkage for all subunits
under the CU.
2.8. Enter *
3. At the MTTY, request a hard copy of the form from the Receive-Only Printer (ROP)
by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
NOTE:
All subdevices under the IOP must be deleted before continuing. Refer to
Chapters 7, 16, 22, 24, 26, and 28 for the IOP subdevice degrowth procedures.
5.3. Enter the unit_name and unit_number values for the IOP being degrown
as provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading... Please wait...
followed by Enter Delete, Validate, or Print:
5.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... in the upper right
corner of the screen and prompts you to remove the
IOP from service.
NOTE:
All subunits are removed from service before the unit
RMV COMPLETED output message is received.
6.2. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> and wait for the prompt.
8. Force CU 0 on-line.
! CAUTION:
The system could sustain a severe maintenance reset while CU 0
is unavailable.
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 1 displays a Force Off-Line (FOFL) indicator and
CU 0 displays a Force On-Line (FONL) indicator.
8.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the Common
Processor Display Page (CPDP).
! CAUTION:
The system may sustain a severe maintenance if the mate CU is unavailable.
9. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821 [at Equipment Location (EQL)
53-060], power down CU 1 by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
NOTE:
Step 9 prevents automatic restoral of the CU 1 when the unit is powered up
later in this procedure.
10. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key and wait for the prompt.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
11. Disconnect the control cables from the Out-of-Service (OOS) Dual Serial Channel
(DSCH) and degrowth IOP.
12. At the MTTY, clear all force conditions on the CU by entering 13 on the command
line of the EAI page.
Response: The EAI page CU status is cleared of the force condition.
14. At the MTTY, restore CU 1 to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:CU=a:UCL;
If PDS, RST:CU a;UCL!
15. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key and wait for the prompt.
16. Switch CU 1.
SWITCH CU 1 PROCEDURE:
16.1. At the MTTY, switch CU 1 by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
NOTE:
During a Recent Change (RC) session, access the EAI page by
pressing the EA DISP key. Return to RC by pressing the
NORM DISP key.
17.2. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key and wait for the prompt.
! CAUTION:
The system may sustain a severe maintenance reset while CU 0 is
unavailable.
18. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove CU 0 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 18 provides automatic restoral of CU 0 when the unit is powered up later
in this procedure.
19. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key and wait for the prompt.
20. Disconnect the control cables from the OOS DSCH and the degrowth IOP.
21. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key and wait for the prompt.
22. If the degrowth IOP is the first device under the DSCH, the high-level form will
prompt the user to restore CU 0 (go to Step 26). If a Previous Logical Unit (PLU) to
the IOP exists, the high-level form will prompt the user to remove the PLU (go to
Step 24).
23. Remove the PLU from service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:a=b;
If PDS, RMV:a b!
24. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key and wait for the prompt.
25. At the MTTY, restore the PLU to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
26. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key and wait for the prompt.
27. At the MTTY, clear all force conditions on the CU by entering 13 on the command
line of the EAI page.
Response: The EAI page CU status is cleared of the force condition.
28. At Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS) TN1821 (EQL 28-060), restore
power to CU 0 by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and
releasing to the ON position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED
At IOPPS TN1821 (EQL-28-060), the OOS LED lights.
29. At the MTTY, restore CU 0 to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:CU=a:UCL;
If PDS, RST:CU a;UCL!
NOTE:
Wait for the FORM DELETED indicator in the upper right corner of the screen.
31.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
34. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
10
Contents
Introduction 10-1
Prerequisite Conditions 10-2
References 10-2
Procedure 10-2
10
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow a new Input/Output Processor (IOP 2 or
IOP 3) into a 3B21D computer system.
During the procedure, the system requests diagnostics, removals, and restorals of
equipment.
If the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY) is used, pressing the CMD/MSG key
enables messages to be entered at the same terminal.
If a Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) terminal is used, another terminal is needed to
input the requested messages.
NOTE 1:
Values for all fields should be provided by application engineering.
NOTE 2:
If using the MTTY to return to the Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) RC/V
session, press the CMD/MSG key twice – once to access the command mode where
graphic displays could be viewed and a second time to return to the ECD RC/V
session.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), IOPs, Moving Head Disks (MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root ECD must be consistent with the incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-105, Hardware Reference Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL
2. Invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode (Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays the executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. Invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the command
mode.
NOTE:
The selected terminal must not be connected to an IOP that is to
be powered down during the growth procedure. Follow local
practices to notify other users of the IOP that is to be powered
down.
2.2.4. Enter the unit_name and unit_number values being grown as provided
by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading… Please wait…
prompts for each field value and then displays
Enter Insert, Change, Substitute, Validate, or
Print:
2.2.5. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting ...
NOTE:
The system begins to make changes to the incore ECD in
response to the data input on the iopadd form. Messages flash
on the screen indicating the database actions currently in
progress.
5. Force CU 0 on-line.
! CAUTION:
The system could sustain a severe maintenance reset while CU 0
is unavailable.
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 1 displays a Force Off-Line (FOFL) indicator and
CU 0 displays a Force On-Line (FONL) indicator.
5.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
6. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), power down CU 1 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
7. Ensure that the growth IOP is powered down by pressing the ST/ON/OFF switch to
the OFF position at Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS) TN1820 in the
growth IOP.
8. Connect the Dual Serial Channel (DSCH) cable from the IOP being grown to the
proper Direct Memory Access (DMA) pack (at EQL 53-075) on CU 1.
Response: The system begins to make changes to the incore ECD in
response to the data input on the iopadd form. A transaction
block is executed to update the growth IOP unit control block
(ucb) form with channel and controller information. Messages
flash on the screen indicating the database actions currently in
progress.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
9.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
CU 1 is restored to service automatically.
10.2. At the MTTY, check the diagnostic message queue by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, OP:DMQ;
If PDS, OP:DMQ!
NOTE:
Observe the ROP output for the restoral of CU 1 in progress, and
wait until CU 1 is restored to standby before continuing.
12. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove CU 0 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 12 prevents automatic restoral of CU 0 when the unit is powered up later
in this procedure.
! CAUTION:
The system could sustain a severe maintenance reset while CU 1
is unavailable.
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 0 displays an FOFL indicator and CU 1 displays
an FONL indicator.
13.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
14. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), power down CU 0 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 0
NOTE:
The iopadd session running on the RC/V terminal indicates which
unit to remove. Wait for the unit to be removed from service before
continuing.
17. At the MTTY, restore the PLU by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
18.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
CU 0 is restored to service automatically.
CU 0 OOS Light-Emitting Diode (LED) extinguishes.
19.2. At MTTY CPDP 102, observe the ROP output for the restoral of CU 0 in
progress and wait until CU 0 is restored to standby before continuing.
NOTE:
If growing in IOP 2, remove IOP 0 from service and connect the
Scanner and Signal Distributor (SCSD) cable at this time. If
growing in IOP 3, remove IOP 1 from service and connect the
SCSD cable at this time.
20. At IOPPS TN1820, restore power to the growth IOP by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED IOP a
21. At the MTTY, diagnose the growth IOP by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, DGN:IOP=a;
If PDS, DGN:IOP a!
22. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove CU 0 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 22 prevents automatic restoral of CU 0 when the unit is powered up later
in this procedure.
23. At the MTTY, diagnose growth IOP with CU 0 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:IOP=a ;PH=15,CU=0;
If PDS, DGN:IOP a ;PH 15,CU 0!
24. At the MTTY, restore CU 0 to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:CU=0,UCL;
If PDS, RST:CU 0,UCL!
27. At the MTTY, diagnose the growth IOP with CU 1 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:IOP=a;PH=15,CU=1;
If PDS, DGN:IOP a;PH 15,CU 1!
28. At the MTTY, restore CU 1 to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:CU=1,UCL;
If PDS, RST:CU 1,UCL!
29.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
31. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
32. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
11
Contents
Introduction 11-1
Prerequisite Conditions 11-1
Configuration 11-2
References 11-2
Procedure 11-2
11
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow an Input/Output Processor (IOP) Small
Computer System Interface (SCSI) peripheral unit into a processor cabinet of a 3B21D
computer system. The peripheral unit provides additional slots for the growth of the IOP
control circuits and SCSI Peripheral Units (SPUs).
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), IOPs, Moving Head Disks (MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
Configuration
The peripheral unit for the 3B21D computer provides flexibility in that either the IOP control
circuits or the SPUs can be grown in any slot.
! CAUTION:
Due to thermal restrictions, do not grow disks above the double high KLW circuit
boards (KLWmm, KLWcc) because the heat may affect disk operation.
Drawing J3T061A-1 contains the equipment configuration options that are supported and
shows the optional placements of the IOP control circuits and SPUs.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
Common Systems Specification for 3B21D Computer System, J3T060A-1,
J3T060AB-1, and J3T061A-1
Application specific installation engineering documentation for the 3B21D computer
Drawing ED-3T083-30
254-303-105, Hardware Reference Manual (power distribution and control chapters
and cabling information).
Procedure
The following steps describe the IOP/SCSI peripheral unit growth procedure:
1. At the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY), inhibit automatic diagnostics by entering
the appropriate input command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
3. Install the cables and power connections per drawing J3T061A-1. For fuse
assignments, refer to drawing J3T061A-1.
NOTE:
This completes the installation of the growth unit. To continue with the growth
of an IOP control circuit, refer to Chapters 8, 10, 17, 23, 25, 27, and 29.
If growing an SPU, MHD, Digital Audio Tape (DAT), or 9-track tape, refer to
Chapter 20, ‘‘SCSI Peripheral Growth.’’
5. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
12
Contents
Introduction 12-1
Prerequisite Conditions 12-1
References 12-2
Required Tools and Equipment 12-2
Procedure 12-2
12
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure needed to grow additional Single In-line Memory
Modules (SIMMs) into a 3B21D computer system. A SIMM may be either 8 or 32
megabytes. The procedure in this chapter is used for both memory sizes.
Instructions for changing the KLWmm circuit pack labeling information are included as part
of this procedure.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
Information Product (IP) 254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual, must be
available for reference during this growth procedure.
Procedure
This procedure identifies the existing size of the maximum number of memory pages that
the operating system can be configured. This value is obtained in the pages field of the
boot time parameters (btparm) form in the incore database.
Since the memory will be increased, the value of the pages must be large enough to
accommodate the additional memory growth. If it is not, then pages value must be
increased before proceeding to memory growth.
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.7. Compare the value of pages (Step 1.4) with the corresponding memory
size and the circuit pack in Table 12-1 to determine the proper value for
the pages field to accommodate the memory growth.
1.8. Determine if the pages value is large enough for intended growth.
If yes, go to Step 3.
If no, continue to Step 2.
This following subprocedure updates the btparm form (pages field) to reflect
the memory size for the intended growth. The update is performed at either the
Master Control Center (MCC) terminal or the Supplementary Trunk and Line
Work Station (STLWS) terminal. Once completed, then a boot of the database
is performed.
2.1. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the command
mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2.2.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.6. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
2.7. Enter 7
Response: The cursor moves to the pages field.
2.10. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating...FORM EXECUTED
followed by the Boot Time Parameters form.
The cursor moves to the btparmname key field.
2.12.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
! WARNING:
The following step will momentarily affect call processing.
Coordinate this step with the customer before booting, and
schedule the boot during an appropriate low traffic period.
NOTE:
Booting the system is required on the Emergency Action Interface
(EAI) page.
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will
periodically appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
5. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821 [at Equipment Location (EQL)
28-060], remove CU 0 from service by operating the ROS/RST switch to the ROS
position.
NOTE:
Step 5 prevents automatic restoral of the CU 0 when the unit is powered up
later in this procedure.
7. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), power down CU 0 by operating the ST/ON/OFF
switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 0
! CAUTION:
If not previously set up, set up a static-free area by placing an antistatic mat
near the 3B21D computer and properly ground the mat to the computer. If a
work table and/or chair is used, it should also be properly grounded.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent
damage to components.
8.1. Wearing a properly grounded wrist strap, remove the KLWmm (memory)
circuit pack at EQL 28-008, place it in an antistatic container, and
transfer the circuit pack to the properly grounded work area for the
update procedure.
8.2. Install the SIMM in the desired SIMM socket on the KLWmm circuit pack.
NOTE:
Three sockets (SIMM 1, SIMM 2, and SIMM 3) are available for
memory growth. Varying combinations of 32- or 8-megabyte
SIMMs can be used to equip the needed memory. Table 12-2
shows the combinations that are supported. When inserting a
SIMM, the leftmost empty socket should be used.
8.3. To insert a SIMM, line up the pins on the SIMM to the pins in the socket
and verify the location of the keying slot. Gently press the SIMM in
place. Two small metal braces should clasp the SIMM to hold it in place.
Refer to Figure 12.1.
SIMM 2
SIMM 1 SIMM 3
Faceplate
Backplane
Connectors
NOTE:
In some instances of memory growth, you may need to replace an
8-megabyte SIMM with a 32-megabyte SIMM to equip the
appropriate amount of memory. In this case, first remove the
8-megabyte SIMM that is no longer needed. This is done by gently
pushing down on the metal braces at the top and bottom of the
SIMM and gently pulling upward on the SIMM. The SIMM will pop
out easily. Once this is done, insert the new SIMM in the
appropriate location as previously instructed.
8.4. Attach the new memory label over the existing label on the KLWmm
circuit pack. The new label should match the total memory after the
growth procedure is completed.
8.5. Wearing a properly grounded wrist strap, place the updated KLWmm
(memory) circuit pack in an antistatic container, transfer the circuit pack
to the 3B21D computer, and insert it in EQL 28-008.
9. Note the equipage information for the Main Store Controller (MASC) changes.
Table 12-2 lists the equipage values and the SIMM assignments needed when
making the updates to the MASC unit control block (ucb) forms in the following
steps. Refer to Table 12-2 as needed in the procedure.
10. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 10.1) or the command mode (Step 11).
10.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
10.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
11. Access the ECD using the command mode by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
12.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
13.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
13.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
13.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
13.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or print:
13.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
13.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
NOTE:
Refer to Table 12-2 for the correct equipage value for total memory
size.
13.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
14.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
15. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), restore CU 0 to service by operating the
ST/ON/OFF to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
16. At the MTTY, diagnose the CU 0 MASC by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, DGN:CU=0,MASC=0,RAW,DEX,TLP;
If PDS, DGN:CU 0,MASC 0;RAW,DEX,TLP!
NOTE:
Ensure all phases achieve an ATP condition before continuing.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
17.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
18. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), restore CU 0 to service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the RST position. This causes the CU to automatically restore
with diagnostics.
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics run ATP and the CU has been marked
standby.
19.2. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
20. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), remove CU 1 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Step 20 prevents automatic restoral of the CU 1 when the unit is powered up in
this procedure.
22. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), remove power from OOS CU 1 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
NOTE:
Three sockets (SIMM 1, SIMM 2, and SIMM 3) are available for
memory growth. Varying combinations of 32- or 8-megabyte
SIMMS can be used to equip the needed memory. Table 12-2
shows the combinations that are supported. When inserting a
SIMM, the leftmost empty socket should be used.
23.3. To insert a SIMM, line up the pins on the SIMM to the pins in the socket
and verify the location of the keying slot. Gently press the SIMM in
place. Two small metal braces should clasp the SIMM to hold it in place.
NOTE:
In some instances of memory growth, it may be necessary to
replace an 8-megabyte SIMM with a 32-megabyte SIMM to equip
the appropriate amount of memory. In this case, first remove the
8-megabyte SIMM that is no longer needed. This is done by gently
pushing down on the metal braces at the top and bottom of the
SIMM and gently pulling upward on the SIMM. The SIMM will pop
out easily. Once this is done, insert the new SIMM in the
appropriate location as previously instructed.
23.4. Attach the new memory label over the existing label on the KLWmm
circuit pack. The new label should match the size of the total memory
after the growth procedure is completed.
23.5. Wearing a properly grounded wrist strap, place the updated KLWmm
(memory) circuit pack in an antistatic container, transfer the circuit pack
to the 3B21D computer, and insert it into EQL 53-008.
24.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
25.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
25.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
25.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
25.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or print:
25.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
25.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
NOTE:
Refer to Table 12-2 for the correct equipage value for total memory
size.
25.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
26.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
27. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), restore power to CU 1 by pressing the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
28. At the MTTY, diagnose the off-line CU 1 MASC by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:CU=1,MASC=0,RAW,DEX,TLP;
If PDS, DGN:CU 1,MASC 0,RAW,DEX,TLP!
NOTE:
Ensure all phases achieve an ATP condition before continuing.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
29.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
30. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), restore CU 1 to service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the RST position. This causes the CU to automatically restore
with diagnostics.
NOTE:
Do not proceed until all diagnostics run ATP and CU 1 has been marked
standby.
NOTE:
Where XXXXX is the actual number of pages of
memory.
34.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
35. Update the ECD for rootdmly. Repeat Steps 10 through 14 for CU 0 mainstore 0
and 24 through 26 using rootdmly instead of incore when preparing the ECD RC/V
terminal, then continue to Step 36.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
37. At the MTTY, allow Routine Exercises (REXs) by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
38. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
13
Contents
Introduction 13-1
Prerequisite Conditions 13-2
References 13-2
Overview of Conversion from UN583 to
UN597 9600 Baud ROP 13-2
UN583 to UN597 9600 Baud ROP Procedure 13-3
Overview of Conversion of UN597 with 1200
Baud ROP to UN597 with 9600 Baud
ROP 13-30
UN597 with 1200 Baud ROP to UN597 with
9600 Baud ROP Procedure 13-31
13
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedures used to convert from a UN583 Maintenance
Teletypewriter Controller (MTTYC) circuit pack with 1200 baud Receive-Only Printer (ROP)
to a UN597 MTTYC circuit pack with 9600 baud ROP or to convert from a UN597 circuit
pack with 1200 baud ROP to a UN597 circuit pack with 9600 baud ROP into a 3B21D
computer system. Site requirements will dictate which procedure is applicable.
The 9600 baud ROP feature on the UN597 circuit pack is only supported in Real-Time
Reliable (RTR) Release 21.27 and later field releases.
The UN597 MTTYC circuit pack with 1200 baud ROP will be shipped with all new releases
beginning with RTR Release 21.27.
If problems are encountered during this procedure, contact the next level of technical
support. Read through this entire procedure before starting.
! CAUTION:
To ensure the MTTY and the ROP remain attached to the IOP (IOP 0 or IOP 1) that is
active, extreme caution should be used when executing this procedure.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours, the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, overloads, or other problems; for
example, Peripheral Controller (PC) recoveries, power problems, etc.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
This procedure assumes that a Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) terminal is
available at all times.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
procedure:
254-303-101, Routine Maintenance Tasks Manual
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Perform the following steps to convert a 3B21D computer from a UN583 MTTYC circuit
pack with 1200 baud ROP to a UN597 circuit pack with the 9600 baud ROP feature:
1. At the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY), inhibit automatic maintenance requests
by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE 1:
At the ROP, the following response will periodically appear: REPT DMQ
INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
NOTE 2:
For this procedure, the ECD should be accessed by command mode only.
2. Verify both switches on the port switch circuit pack UN377 [at Equipment Location
(EQL) 45-186] are in the AUTO position and if not, operate switches to the AUTO
position.
NOTE:
To do the conversion for MTTYC 1, use an RC/V terminal that is not controlled
by IOP 1.
3. Testing of the MTTYCs from both CUs require execution of Steps 3.1 through 3.15.
NOTE:
The following subprocedure is not optional; perform as listed.
3.5. At the MTTY, switch the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:MTTY!
3.7. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
3.8. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 1 and that CU 0 is active.
3.11. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 1 and that CU 1 is active.
3.12. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 with CU 1
active by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
3.13. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 0 and that CU 1 is active.
3.15. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 0 and that CU 0 is active.
4. Set both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 45-186) to MTTYC 0.
NOTE:
IOP units may be equipped with simplex Peripheral Controllers (PCs). Before
removing any IOP, if necessary, notify the users of the simplex PCs.
5. At the MTTY, remove IOP 1 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=1;
If PDS, RMV:IOP 1!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
6. At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 45-080), remove power from IOP 1 by operating the
START/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP 1
At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 45-080), the OFF LED lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
8. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
NOTE:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command will be used in
Step 60.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc1";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc1"!
9.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
Table 13-1 indicates the fields that need to be updated on the unit control block
(ucb) form in the ECD to reflect the correct values for the UN597 circuit pack
with 9600 baud ROP.
10.2. Enter u
Response: The system displays a blank unit control block (ucb)
form.
The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
10.6. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
10.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
10.10. Enter 62
Response: The cursor moves to the packcode: attribute.
10.12. Enter 63
Response: The cursor moves to the issue: attribute.
10.13. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.15. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
11.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
12. At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 45-080), restore service to IOP 1 by operating the
START/ON/OFF switch to the START position and releasing to the ON position to
power up IOP 1.
NOTE:
The OFF LED at IOP 1 extinguishes.
CU 0 OOS LED extinguishes.
NOTE 1:
IOP 1 and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching the
CPDP.
NOTE 2:
DO NOT STOP DIAGNOSTICS ONCE THEY HAVE STARTED. If diagnostics
are stopped before MTTYC is diagnosed, the update for the conversion will not
occur.
NOTE 3:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
14. At the MTTY, remove CU 1 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, either 201 Poke command or RMV:CU=1;
If PDS, either 201 Poke command or RMV:CU 1!
NOTE:
Do not proceed until CU 1 has been marked standby.
18.3. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
NOTE:
The following step assumes CU 0 is on standby. If necessary, execute a switch
to achieve the configuration by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
19. At the MTTY, remove CU 0 from service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, either 200 Poke command or RMV:CU=0;
If PDS, either 200 Poke command or RMV:CU 0!
NOTE:
Do not proceed until CU 0 has been marked standby.
23. Set both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 045-186) to the AUTO
position.
24. At the ROP, refer to the hardware owner’s manual to determine how to change the
baud rate from 1200 to 9600.
NOTE:
Unintelligible characters may be displayed until after the ROP is switched.
25. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
26. At the MTTY, switch the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:MTTY!
NOTE:
If Step 26 does not cause output messages on the ROP, contact technical
support.
27. Soak the changes for 15 minutes before performing the remaining steps.
NOTE 1:
To do the conversion for MTTYC 0, an RC/V terminal that is not controlled by
IOP 0 must be used.
NOTE 2:
IOP units may be equipped with simplex PCs. Before removing any IOP, if
necessary, notify the users of the simplex PCs.
28. At the MTTY, remove IOP 0 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=0;
If PDS, RMV:IOP 0!
NOTE 1:
At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 19-080), the OOS LED lights.
NOTE 2:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
29. Set both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 45-186) to MTTYC 1.
30. At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 19-080), remove power from IOP 0 by operating the
START/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP 0
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 19-080), the OFF LED at IOP 0 lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
31. Replace MTTYC 0 circuit pack at EQL 19-094.
32. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
NOTE 1:
The echo directory and filename used in this step will be used in Step 62.
NOTE 2:
Be sure the filename used with the echo command is different from the
filename used in Step 8.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc0";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc0"!
33.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
Table 13-1 indicates the fields that need to be updated on the ucb form in the
ECD to reflect the correct values for the UN597 circuit pack with 9600 baud
ROP.
34.1. At the RC/V terminal, enter ucb
Response: The system displays Enter Database Operation
I=Insert R=Review U=Update D=Delete :
34.2. Enter u
Response: The system displays a blank ucb form.
The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
34.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
34.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
34.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
34.10. Enter 62
Response: The cursor moves to the packcode: attribute.
34.12. Enter 63
Response: The cursor moves to the issue: attribute.
34.13. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
34.15. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
35.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
36. At IOPPS TN1820 for IOP 0 (at EQL 19-080), restore service to IOP 0 by operating
the START/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position to
power up IOP 0.
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820 for IOP 0 (at EQL 19-080), the OFF LED at IOP 0
extinguishes.
NOTE 1:
IOP 0 and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching the
CPDP.
NOTE 2:
DO NOT STOP DIAGNOSTICS ONCE THEY HAVE STARTED. If diagnostics
are stopped before MTTYC is diagnosed, the update for the conversion will not
occur.
NOTE 3:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
38. At the MTTY, remove CU 1 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, either 201 Poke command or RMV:CU=1;
If PDS, either 201 Poke command or RMV:CU 1!
NOTE:
Do not proceed until CU 1 has been marked standby.
42.3. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
NOTE:
The following step assumes CU 0 is on standby. If necessary, execute a switch to
achieve the configuration by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
43. At the MTTY, remove CU 0 from service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, either 200 Poke command or RMV:CU=0;
If PDS, either 200 Poke command or RMV:CU 0!
NOTE:
Do not proceed until CU 0 has been marked standby.
47. Set both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 45-186) to the AUTO
position.
48. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
49. At the MTTY, switch the MTTY to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:MTTY!
NOTE:
If Step 49 does cause output messages on the ROP, contact technical support.
50. Soak the changes 30 minutes before performing the remaining steps.
51. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
55. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to MTTYC 1 and that
CU 1 is active.
56. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
58. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
59.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
60. At the RC/V terminal update the ECD for rootdmly for MTTYC 1. Invoke the
rootdmly database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
NOTE:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command are found in
Step 8.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc1";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc1"!
61. Check that no errors occurred during this RC/V session by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, EXC:ENVIR:DATA,UPROC,FN="/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err";
If PDS, EXC:ENVIR:UPROC,FN "/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err"!
62. At the RC/V terminal, update the ECD for rootdmly for MTTYC 0. Invoke the
rootdmly database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
NOTE:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command are found in
Step 32.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc0";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echdmttyc0"!
63. Check that no errors occurred during this RC/V session by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, EXC:ENVIR:DATA,UPROC,FN="/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err";
If PDS, EXC:ENVIR:UPROC,FN "/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err"!
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
65. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
66. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Perform the following steps to update the 3B21D computer from a UN597 MTTYC circuit
pack with 1200 baud ROP to a UN597 circuit pack with 9600 baud ROP.
1. At the MTTY, inhibit automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE 1:
At the ROP, the following response will periodically appear: REPT DMQ
INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
NOTE 2:
For this procedure, the ECD should be accessed by command mode only.
2. Verify that both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 45-186) are in
the AUTO position and if not, operate switches to the AUTO position.
3. Testing of the MTTYCs from both CUs require execution of Steps 3.1 through 3.14.
NOTE:
The following subprocedure is not optional; perform as listed.
3.5. At the MTTY, switch the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:MTTY!
3.7. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
3.8. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 1 and that CU 0 is active.
3.10. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 1 and that CU 1 is active.
3.11. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 with CU 1
active by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
3.12. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 0 and that CU 1 is active.
3.14. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 0 and that CU 0 is active.
4. At the MTTY, remove MTTYC 1 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:MTTYC=1;
If PDS, RMV:MTTYC 1!
5. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
NOTE:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command will be used in
Step 32.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc1";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc1"!
6.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
! CAUTION:
Before updating the ucb record, if field 22 is anything but a 2, seek technical
support before continuing.
7.2. Enter u
Response: The system displays a blank ucb form.
The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
7.6. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
7.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
7.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
7.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
8.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE 1:
DO NOT STOP DIAGNOSTICS ONCE THEY HAVE STARTED. If diagnostics
are stopped before the MTTYC is diagnosed, the update for the conversion will
not occur.
NOTE 2:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
10. At the ROP, refer to the hardware owner’s manual to determine how to change the
baud rate from 1200 to 9600.
NOTE:
Unintelligible characters may be displayed until after the ROP is switched.
11. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
12. At the MTTY, switch the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:MTTY!
NOTE:
If Step 12 does not cause output messages on the ROP, contact technical
support.
13. Soak the changes for 15 minutes before performing the remaining steps.
14. At the MTTY, remove MTTYC 0 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:MTTYC=0;
If PDS, RMV:MTTYC 0!
15. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
NOTE 1:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command will be used in
Step 34.
NOTE 2:
Be sure the filename used with the echo command is different from the
filename used in Step 4.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc0";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc0"!
16.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
! CAUTION:
Before updating the ucb record, if field 22 is anything but a 2, seek technical
support before continuing.
The following table indicates the field that needs to be updated on the ucb form
in the ECD to reflect the correct values for the UN597 circuit pack with 9600
baud ROP.
17.2. Enter u
Response: The system displays a blank ucb form.
The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
17.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
17.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
17.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
18.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
19. At the MTTY, restore MTTYC 0 to service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RST:MTTYC=0;
If PDS, RST:MTTYC 0!
NOTE 1:
DO NOT STOP DIAGNOSTICS ONCE THEY HAVE STARTED. If diagnostics
are stopped before MTTYC is diagnosed, the update for the conversion will not
occur.
NOTE 2:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
20. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
21. At the MTTY, switch the MTTY to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:MTTY!
NOTE:
If Step 21 does not cause output messages on the ROP, contact technical
support.
22. Soak the changes for 15 minutes before performing the remaining steps.
NOTE:
These updates are only being soaked for 15 minutes because no hardware is
being changed.
23. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
27. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to MTTYC 1.
28. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
30. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
31.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
32. At the RC/V terminal, update the ECD for rootdmly for MTTYC 1. Invoke the
rootdmly database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
NOTE:
The directory and filename used in the following command are from Step 5.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc1";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc1"!
33. Check that no errors occurred during this RC/V session by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, EXC:ENVIR:DATA,UPROC,FN="/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err";
If PDS, EXC:ENVIR:UPROC,FN "/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err"!
34. At the RC/V terminal, update the ECD for rootdmly for MTTYC 0. Invoke the
rootdmly database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
NOTE:
The directory and filename used in the following command are found in
Step 15.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc0";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc0"!
35. Check that no errors occurred during this RC/V session by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, EXC:ENVIR:DATA,UPROC,FN="/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err";
If PDS, EXC:ENVIR:UPROC,FN "/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err"!
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
37. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
38. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
14
Contents
Introduction 14-1
Prerequisite Conditions 14-2
References 14-2
Overview of UN583 to UN597 ABD Procedure 14-2
UN583 to UN597 ABD Procedure 14-3
Overview of UN597 Without ABD to UN597
with ABD Procedure 14-30
UN597 Without ABD to UN597 with ABD
Procedure 14-31
14
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedures used to convert from a UN583 Maintenance
Teletypewriter Controller (MTTYC) circuit pack to a UN597 MTTYC circuit pack with the
Alternate Book Disk (ABD) feature or to convert from a UN597 circuit pack without the ABD
feature to a UN597 circuit pack with the ABD feature into a 3B21D computer system. Site
requirements will dictate which procedure is applicable.
The ABD feature on the UN597 is only supported in Real-Time Reliable (RTR) Release
21.27 and later field releases including 5E13(1). The UN597 MTTYC circuit pack will be
shipped with all new releases beginning with RTR Release 21.27.
If problems are encountered during this procedure, contact the next level of technical
support. Read through this entire procedure before starting.
! CAUTION:
To ensure the MTTY and the ROP remain attached to the IOP (IOP 0 or IOP 1) that is
active, extreme caution should be used when executing this procedure.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours, the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, overloads, or other problems; for
example, Peripheral Controller (PC) recoveries, power problems, etc.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
This procedure assumes that a Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) terminal is
available at all times.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
procedure:
254-303-101, Routine Maintenance Tasks Manual
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Perform the following steps to convert the 3B21D computer from a UN583 MTTYC circuit
pack to a UN597 circuit pack with the ABD feature:
1. At the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY), inhibit automatic maintenance requests
by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE 1:
At the ROP, the following response will periodically appear: REPT DMQ
INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
NOTE 2:
For this procedure, the ECD should be accessed by command mode only.
2. Verify that both switches on the port switch circuit pack UN377 [at Equipment
Location (EQL) 45-186] are in the AUTO position and if not, operate switches to the
AUTO position.
NOTE:
To do the conversion for MTTYC 1, use an RC/V terminal that is not controlled
by IOP 1.
3. Testing the MTTYCs from both CUs requires execution of Steps 3.1 through 3.15.
NOTE:
The following subprocedure is not optional; perform as listed.
3.5. At the MTTY, switch the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:MTTY!
3.6. At the CPDP, verify that the ROP is connected to the MTTYC 1.
If yes, go to Step 3.8.
If no, continue to Step 3.7.
3.7. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
3.8. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 1 and that CU 0 is active.
3.11. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 1 and that CU 1 is active.
3.12. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 with CU 1
active by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
3.13. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 0 and that CU 1 is active.
3.15. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 0 and that CU 0 is active.
4. Set both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 45-186) to MTTYC 0.
NOTE:
IOP units may be equipped with simplex Peripheral Controllers (PCs). Before
removing any IOP, if necessary, notify the users of the simplex PCs.
5. At the MTTY, remove IOP 1 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=1;
If PDS, RMV:IOP 1!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
6. At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 45-080), remove power from IOP 1 by operating the
START/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP 1
At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 45-080), the OFF LED lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
8. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
NOTE:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command will be used in
Step 62.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc1";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc1"!
9.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
Table 14-1 indicates the fields that need to be updated on the unit control block
(ucb) form in the ECD to reflect the correct values for the UN597 (ABD) circuit
pack.
10.2. Enter u
Response: The system displays a blank ucb form.
The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
10.6. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
10.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
10.10. Enter 27
Response: The cursor moves to the mv: attribute.
10.12. Enter 62
Response: The cursor moves to the packcode: attribute.
10.14. Enter 63
Response: The cursor moves to the issue: attribute.
10.15. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
10.17. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
11.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
13. At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 45-080), restore service to IOP 1 by operating the
START/ON/OFF switch to the START position and releasing to the ON position to
power up IOP 1.
NOTE:
The OFF LED at IOP 1 extinguishes.
CU 0 OOS LED extinguishes.
NOTE 1:
IOP 1 and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching
the CPDP.
NOTE 2:
DO NOT STOP DIAGNOSTICS ONCE THEY HAVE STARTED. If diagnostics
are stopped before the MTTYC is diagnosed, the update for the conversion will
not occur.
NOTE 3:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
15. At MTTY, remove CU 1 from service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, either 201 Poke command or RMV:CU=1;
If PDS, either 201 Poke command or RMV:CU 1!
NOTE:
Do not proceed until CU 1 has been marked standby.
19.3. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
NOTE:
The following step assumes CU 0 is on standby. If necessary, execute a
switch to achieve the configuration by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
20. At the MTTY, remove CU 0 from service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, either 200 Poke command or RMV:CU=0;
If PDS, either 200 Poke command or RMV:CU 0!
NOTE:
Do not proceed until CU 0 has been marked standby.
24. Set both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 45-186) to the AUTO
position.
25. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
26. Verify that the EAI status box is available on the CPDP. At the MTTY, enter Poke
command 102 to display the CPDP.
Response: The EAI status box is available on the CPDP.
27. Soak the changes for 15 minutes before performing the remaining steps.
NOTE 1:
To do the conversion for MTTYC 0, an RC/V terminal that is not controlled by
IOP 0 must be used.
NOTE 2:
IOP units may be equipped with simplex PCs. Before removing any IOP, if
necessary, notify the users of the simplex PCs.
28. At the MTTY, remove IOP 0 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=0;
If PDS, RMV:IOP 0!
NOTE 1:
At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 19-080), the OOS LED lights.
NOTE 2:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
29. Set both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 45-186) to MTTYC 1.
30. At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 19-080), remove power from IOP 0 by operating the
START/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP 0
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820 (at EQL 19-080), the OFF LED at IOP 0 lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
32. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
NOTE 1:
The echo directory and filename used in this step will be used in Step 64.
NOTE 2:
Be sure that the filename used with the echo command is different from the
filename used in Step 8.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc0";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc0"!
33.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
Table 14-1 indicates the fields that need to be updated on the ucb form in the
ECD to reflect the correct values for the UN597 (ABD) circuit pack.
34.1. At the RC/V terminal, enter ucb
Response: The system displays Enter Database Operation
I=Insert R=Review U=Update D=Delete :
34.2. Enter u
Response: The system displays a blank ucb form.
The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
34.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
34.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
34.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
34.10. Enter 27
Response: The cursor moves to the mv: attribute.
34.12. Enter 62
Response: The cursor moves to the packcode: attribute.
34.14. Enter 63
Response: The cursor moves to the issue: attribute.
34.15. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
34.17. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
35.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
36. At IOPPS TN1820 for IOP 0 (at EQL 19-080), restore service to IOP 0 by operating
the START/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position to
power up IOP 0.
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820 for IOP 0 (at EQL 19-080), the OFF LED at IOP 0
extinguishes.
NOTE 1:
IOP 0 and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching the
CPDP.
NOTE 2:
DO NOT STOP DIAGNOSTICS ONCE THEY HAVE STARTED. If diagnostics
are stopped before MTTYC is diagnosed, the update for the conversion will not
occur.
NOTE 3:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
38. At the MTTY, remove CU 1 from service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, either 201 Poke command or RMV:CU=1;
If PDS, either 201 Poke command or RMV:CU 1!
NOTE:
Do not proceed until CU 1 has been marked standby.
42.3. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the CUs have switched.
NOTE:
The following step assumes CU 0 is on standby. If necessary, execute a switch to
achieve the configuration by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
43. At MTTY, remove CU 0 from service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, either 200 Poke command or RMV:CU=0;
If PDS, either 200 Poke command or RMV:CU 0!
NOTE:
Do not proceed until CU 0 has been marked standby.
47. Set both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 45-186) to the AUTO
position.
48. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
49. Verify that the EAI status box is available on the CPDP. At the MTTY, enter Poke
command 102 to display the CPDP.
Response: The EAI status box is available on the CPDP.
50. Soak the changes for 30 minutes before performing the remaining steps.
51. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
52. Verify that the EAI status box is available on the CPDP. At the MTTY, enter Poke
command 102 to display the CPDP.
Response: The EAI status box is available on the CPDP.
56. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to MTTYC 1 and that
CU 1 is active.
57. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
58. Verify that the EAI status box is available on the CPDP. At the MTTY, enter Poke
command 102 to display the CPDP.
Response: The EAI status box is available on the CPDP.
60. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
61.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
62. Update the ECD for rootdmly for MTTYC 1. Invoke the rootdmly database low-
level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input command.
NOTE:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command are found in
Step 8.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc1";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
tmp/echomttyc1"!
63. Check that no errors occurred during this RC/V session by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, EXC:ENVIR:DATA,UPROC,FN="/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err";
If PDS, EXC:ENVIR:UPROC,FN "/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err"!
64. At the RC/V terminal, update the ECD for rootdmly for MTTYC 0. Invoke the
rootdmly database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
NOTE:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command are found in
Step 32.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc0";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"tmp/echdmttyc0"!
65. Check that no errors occurred during this RC/V session by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, EXC:ENVIR:DATA,UPROC,FN="/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err";
If PDS, EXC:ENVIR:UPROC,FN "/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err"!
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
67. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
68. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Perform the following steps to update the 3B21D computer from a UN597 MTTYC circuit
pack without the ABD feature to a UN597 circuit pack with the ABD feature.
1. At the MTTY, inhibit automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE 1:
At the ROP, the following response will periodically appear: REPT DMQ
INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
NOTE 2:
For this procedure, the ECD should be accessed by command mode only.
2. Verify that both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL 45-186) are in
the AUTO position and if not, operate switches to the AUTO position.
3. Testing of the MTTYCs from both CUs require execution of Steps 3.1 through 3.14.
NOTE:
The following subprocedure is not optional; perform as listed.
3.5. At the MTTY, switch the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:MTTY!
3.7. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
3.8. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 1 and that CU 0 is active.
3.9. At the MTTY, switch to CU 1 by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:CU;
If PDS, SW:CU!
3.10. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 1 and that CU 1 is active.
3.11. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 with CU 1
active by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
3.12. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 0 and that CU 1 is active.
3.14. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to
MTTYC 0 and that CU 0 is active.
4. At the MTTY, remove MTTYC 1 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:MTTYC=1;
If PDS, RMV:MTTYC 1!
5. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
NOTE:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command will be used in
Step 36.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc1";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc1"!
6.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
! CAUTION:
Before updating the ucb record, if field 22 is anything but a 2, seek technical
support before continuing.
The following table indicates the field that needs to be updated on the ucb form
in the ECD to reflect the correct values for the UN597 (ABD) circuit pack.
UN597 Without
Field/Name ABD Value UN597 (ABD) Value
22. equipage 0x2 0x3
7.2. Enter u
Response: The system displays a blank ucb form.
The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
7.6. Enter 1
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
7.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
7.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
7.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
8.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
10. At the MTTY, restore MTTYC 1 to service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RST:MTTYC=1;
If PDS, RST:MTTYC 1!
NOTE 1:
DO NOT STOP DIAGNOSTICS ONCE DIAGNOSTICS HAVE STARTED. If
diagnostics are stopped before the MTTYC is diagnosed, the update for the
conversion will not occur.
NOTE 2:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
11. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
12. Verify that the EAI status box is available on the CPDP. At the MTTY, enter Poke
command 102 to display the CPDP.
Response: The EAI status box is available on the CPDP.
13. Soak the changes for 15 minutes before performing the remaining steps.
14. At the MTTY, remove MTTYC 0 from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:MTTYC=0;
If PDS, RMV:MTTYC 0!
15. At the RC/V terminal, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering
the appropriate input command.
NOTE 1:
The echo directory and filename used in the following command will be used in
Step 36.
NOTE 2:
Be sure that the filename used with the echo command is different from the
filename used in Step 5.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc0";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW,ECHO
"/tmp/echomttyc0"!
16.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
The following table indicates the field that needs to be updated on the ucb form
in the ECD to reflect the correct values for the UN597 (ABD) circuit pack.
UN597 Without
Field/Name ABD Value UN597 (ABD) Value
22. equipage 0x2 0x3
17.2. Enter u
Response: The system displays a blank ucb form.
The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
17.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
17.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.8. Enter 22
Response: The cursor moves to the equipage: attribute.
17.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
18.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
19. At the MTTY, restore MTTYC 0 to service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RST:MTTYC=0;
If PDS, RST:MTTYC 0!
NOTE 1:
DO NOT STOP DIAGNOSTICS ONCE DIAGNOSTICS HAVE STARTED. If
diagnostics are stopped before the MTTYC is diagnosed, the update for the
conversion will not occur.
NOTE 2:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
20. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
21. Verify that the EAI status box is available on the CPDP. At the MTTY, enter Poke
command 102 to display the CPDP.
Response: The EAI status box is available on the CPDP.
22. Soak the changes for 15 minutes before performing the remaining steps.
NOTE:
These updates are only being soaked for 15 minutes because no hardware is
being changed.
23. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 1 by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
24. Verify that the EAI status box is available on the CPDP. At the MTTY, enter Poke
command 102 to display the CPDP.
Response: The EAI status box is available on the CPDP.
28. At the CPDP, verify that the MTTY and the ROP are connected to MTTYC 1.
29. At the MTTY, switch the ROP and the MTTY to MTTYC 0 by entering the appropriate
input command at the MTTY.
If MML, SW:PORTSW;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW!
30. Verify that the EAI status box is available on the CPDP. At the MTTY, enter Poke
command 102 to display the CPDP.
Response: The EAI status box is available on the CPDP.
32. At the RC/V, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
33.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
34. At the RC/V terminal, update the ECD for rootdmly for MTTYC 1. Invoke the
rootdmly database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
NOTE:
The directory and filename used in the following command are from Step 5.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc1";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
tmp/echomttyc1"!
35. Check that no errors occurred during this RC/V session by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, EXC:ENVIR:DATA,UPROC,FN="/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err";
If PDS, EXC:ENVIR:UPROC,FN "/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err"!
36. At the RC/V terminal, update the ECD for rootdmly for MTTYC 0. Invoke the
rootdmly database low-level mode RC/V by entering the appropriate input
command.
NOTE:
The directory and filename used in the following command are found in
Step 15.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
"/tmp/echomttyc0";
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "rootdmly",NREVIEW,STDIN
tmp/echomttyc0"!
37. Check that no errors occurred during this RC/V session by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, EXC:ENVIR:DATA,UPROC,FN="/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err";
If PDS, EXC:ENVIR:UPROC,FN "/bin/cat /etc/rcvecd.err"!
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
39. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
40. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
15
Contents
Introduction 15-1
Prerequisite Conditions 15-1
Configuration 15-2
References 15-2
Procedure 15-2
15
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow a peripheral cabinet into a 3B21D
computer system. The peripheral cabinet houses the Small Computer System Interface
(SCSI) 9-track tape units.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exit in the system before starting this growth procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
Configuration
Two peripheral cabinets may be grown into the 3B21D computer. Each cabinet can house
up to two 9-track tape units. The upper 9-track tape unit is mounted in each peripheral
cabinet frame when delivered from the factory. This procedure describes how to grow the
peripheral cabinet(s) and mount the lower 9-track tape unit(s). The 9-track tape units are
grown using the SCSI Peripheral Unit (SPU) high-level forms growth procedure that
describes how to complete system Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) changes.
Refer to Chapter 20, ‘‘SCSI Peripheral Growth.’’
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
Common Systems Specification for 3B21D Computer System, J3T061A-1
Common Systems Specification for 3B21D Computer Peripheral Growth Cabinet,
J3T059A-1
Application specific installation engineering documentation for the 3B21D computer
Drawing ED-3T083-30.
Procedure
The following steps describe the procedure for growing a peripheral cabinet:
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
3. Install the cable assemblies as shown in J3T061A-1 between the processor cabinet
and the peripheral cabinet, and connect as directed.
4. Perform the power verification test. Refer to the application specific installation
engineering documentation for the 3B21D computer.
NOTE:
This completes the installation of the growth cabinet.
To continue with growth of the SCSI 9-track tape unit, follow the SCSI SPU
high-level forms growth procedure in Chapter 20, ‘‘SCSI Peripheral Growth.’’
6. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
16
Contents
Introduction 16-1
Prerequisite Conditions 16-1
References 16-2
Procedure 16-2
16
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow a Scanner and Signal Distributor
Controller (SCSDC) from a 3B21D computer system.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing the ECD using either the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode
(Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
The following subprocedure provides the Unit Control Block (UCB) pointer list which
shows the form and record names which must be removed later in this procedure.
3.5. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the form_type: attribute.
3.10. Enter aa
Where: aa = unit number of the SCSDC being removed.
3.11. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
4. At the MTTY, request hard copies from the ROP for later use by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
5. Determine the Previous Logical Unit (PLU) and the Next Logical Unit (NLU).
5.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP from which the SCSDC will be
degrown.
5.5. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
6. At the MTTY, remove the SCSDC from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:SCSDC=a;
If PDS, RMV:SCSDC a!
7.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
8.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
8.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the SCSDC being degrown.
8.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
8.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
8.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
9.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
10.2. Verify that the port switches, located at the bottom of the processor
cabinet, are both in the AUTO position.
10.3. At the MTTY, switch to another IOP by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW MTTY!
10.4. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that the ROP is connected to the IOP from
which the SCSDC is to be degrown.
If yes, continue to Step 10.5
If no, go to Step 10.7.
10.5. Verify that the port switches, located at the bottom of the processor
cabinet, are both in the AUTO position.
10.6. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to another IOP by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW ROP!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
11. At IOPPS TN1820, remove power from IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch
to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP a
The OFF LED at the IOP a lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
13. At IOPPS TN1820 restore power to IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to the
ST position and releasing to the ON position. Refer to Table 16-1 for a list of
IOPPS EQLs.
NOTE 1:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED at IOP a extinguishes.
NOTE 2:
The IOP and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching
the CPDP.
14. Determine if the degrowth SCSDC is the first device under the IOP channel and if
other devices exist under the channel.
If the degrowth SCSDC is the first device under the IOP channel, continue to
Step 15 and then go to Step 17.
If the degrowth SCSDC is not the first device under the IOP channel, go to
Step 16 and then continue Step 17.
15. Update the ECD linkages for the degrowth SCSDC when the SCSDC is the first
device under the IOP channel.
15.1.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
15.2. Modify the IOP down pointers to bypass the degrowth SCSDC.
15.2.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name:
attribute.
15.2.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
15.2.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.2.8. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
15.2.9. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that is,
the degrowth SCSDC is at the end of the chain).
15.2.10. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_number:
attribute.
15.2.11. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that
is, the degrowth SCSDC is at the end of the chain).
15.2.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
15.3.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the SCSDC being degrown.
15.3.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.3.6. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
15.3.7. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.3.8. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
15.3.9. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.3.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
15.4.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
16. Update the ECD linkages for the degrowth SCSDC when the SCSDC is not the first
logical unit under the IOP.
NOTE:
The PLU name and number were obtained in Step 3.
16.2.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
16.3.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name:
attribute.
16.3.5. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
16.3.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
16.3.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.3.8. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
16.3.9. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that is,
the degrowth SCSDC is at the end of the chain).
16.3.10. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
16.3.11. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that
is, the degrowth SCSDC is at the end of the chain).
16.3.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
16.4.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the degrowth SCSDC.
16.4.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.6. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
16.4.7. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.8. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
16.4.9. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.10. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
16.4.11. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.12. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
16.4.13. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.4.15. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
16.5.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
16.6. At the MTTY, restore the PLU to service by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
NOTE:
The PLU name and number were obtained in Step 3.
17.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
18.1.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
18.1.3. Enter the mdct record name of the SCSDC being degrown.
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form
and displays Enter Delete, Validate, screen#, or
Print:
18.1.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
18.2.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
18.2.3. Enter the ucb record name of the SCSDC being degrown.
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form
and displays Enter Delete, Validate, screen#, or
Print:
18.2.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... FORM DELETED
Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate, screen#,
or Print:
18.3. Delete the scanner and signal distributor option block head (scsdopt)
form.
18.3.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
18.3.3. Enter the scsdopt record name of the SCSDC being degrown.
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form
and displays Enter Delete, Validate, screen#, or
Print:
18.3.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... FORM DELETED
Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate, screen#,
or Print:
18.4.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
19.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
21. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
22. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
17
Contents
Introduction 17-1
Prerequisite Conditions 17-1
References 17-2
Procedure 17-2
17
Introduction
This chapter provides the procedure used to grow a Scanner and Signal Distributor
Controller (SCSDC) (UN33/UN933 circuit packs) into a 3B21D computer system. The
procedure in this chapter is a generic procedure. Refer to Chapter 21, ‘‘SCSDC16 Growth,’’
for the specific procedure.
NOTE:
UN33 and UN933 circuit packs cannot be mixed in an office.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the system has not experienced any terminal
suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing the ECD using either the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode
(Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
3. Determine the Previous Logical Unit (PLU) and the Next Logical Unit (NLU).
3.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP onto which the SCSDC will be
grown.
NOTE:
The pc (in link order) attribute displays the Unit Control Block
(UCB) linkage for IOP a subdevices. If the SCSDC is not the first
unit under the IOP (that is, there are other units under the IOP),
examine the unitname and unitnumber attributes under the
unitname and unitnumber columns and determine which unit is
the PLU and which unit is the NLU to the growth SCSDC. It is
important to note that the PLU will be removed from service in
Step 13. Note the unitname and unitnumber attributes for the
PLU and NLU. These values will be used in the following steps.
3.5. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
4.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
5.1.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
5.1.3. Populate all fields of the ucb form except fields 36 (down), 41 (side),
46 (cntrl_0), and 51 (cntrl_1). The fields in Table 17-1 contain default
values for fields that are static. All other field values must be as
provided by application engineering.
Field Value
11. device_port IOP
12. device_type SCSD
30. pathname pu/scsdc
56. error_table ioperr
66. u_model 5
5.1.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM
INSERTED followed by
Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate, screen#,
or Print:
5.2.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
5.2.3. Populate all fields of the mdct form. Static field values are described
in Table 17-2. Other field values must be as provided by application
engineering.
Field Value
2. logical_device io
3. mdct_type s
5.2.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM
INSERTED
The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
5.3. Insert the scanner and signal distributor option block head (scsdopt)
form.
5.3.2. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
5.3.3. Enter the option name of the scsdopt record for the growth SCSDC.
5.3.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM
INSERTED
The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
6.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
7.2. Verify that both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 [at
Equipment Location (EQL) 45-186] are in the AUTO position and if not,
operate switches to the AUTO position.
7.3. At the MTTY, switch to another IOP a by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW MTTY!
7.4. At MTTY CPDP 102, verify that ROP is connected to IOP a on which the
SCSDC is to be grown.
If yes, continue to Step 7.5.
If no, go to Step 7.7.
7.5. Verify that both switches on port switch circuit pack UN377 (at EQL
45-186) are in the AUTO position and if not, operate switches to the
AUTO position.
7.6. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to another IOP a by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW=ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW ROP!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
8. At IOPPS TN1820, remove power from IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch
to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP a
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap to prevent damage to components while
handling circuit packs.
10. At IOPPS TN1820, restore power to IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to
the ST position and releasing to the ON position. Refer to Table 17-3 for a list of
IOPPS EQLs.
NOTE 1:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED extinguishes.
NOTE 2:
IOP a and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching
the CPDP.
12. Update the ECD linkages for the SCSDC growth when the SCSDC is the first logical
unit.
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
12.2.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
12.3.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name:
attribute.
12.3.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
12.3.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
12.3.8. Enter 39
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_name:
attribute.
12.3.10. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the down unit_number:
attribute.
12.3.11. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the SCSDC.
12.3.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
12.4. Update the SCSDC cntrl pointers and major status to GROW.
12.4.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the SCSDC being grown.
12.4.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
12.4.6. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
12.4.8. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
12.4.9. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
12.4.10. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
12.4.11. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
12.4.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
12.5.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE 1:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED extinguishes.
NOTE 2:
IOP a and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically
because the ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor
the progress by watching the CPDP.
NOTE:
Wait for all subunits of the IOP to restore before continuing.
13. Update the ECD linkages for the SCSDC growth as an added unit to the IOP.
NOTE:
The PLU name and number were obtained in Step 3.
13.2.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
13.3.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name:
attribute.
13.3.5. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
13.3.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
13.3.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
13.3.8. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
13.3.10. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
13.3.11. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth SCSDC.
13.3.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
13.4. Update the SCSDC side and cntrl pointers and major status to GROW.
13.4.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the growth SCSDC.
13.4.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
13.4.6. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name:
attribute.
13.4.7. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that is,
the growth SCSDC is at the end of the chain).
13.4.8. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
13.4.9. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU (that
is, the growth SCSDC is at the end of the chain).
13.4.10. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
13.4.12. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
13.4.13. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the IOP.
13.4.14. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
13.4.17. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM
UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
13.5.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
13.6. At the MTTY, restore the PLU to service by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, RST:a=b;
If PDS, RST:a b!
NOTE:
The PLU name and number were obtained in Step 3.
14. At the MTTY, diagnose the growth SCSDC by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DGN:SCSDC=a,RAW,TLP;
If PDS, DGN:SCSDC a,RAW,TLP!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
15.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
16.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
16.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the SCSDC being grown.
16.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
16.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
16.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
17.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
18. At the MTTY, restore the SCSDC by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:SCSDC=a;
If PDS, RST:SCSDC a!
19.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
21. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
22. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
18
Contents
Introduction 18-1
Prerequisite Conditions 18-1
References 18-2
Procedure 18-2
18
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow a Small Computer System Interface
(SCSI) 9-track tape device from a 3B21D computer system. If the 9-track tape device being
degrown is Magnetic Tape (MT) 0 and the intent is to replace it with a Digital Audio Tape
(DAT) device, the DAT device will need to be grown after performing this procedure. Refer
to Chapter 20, ‘‘SCSI Peripheral Growth,’’ for the procedure for growing the DAT.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and MT.
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
The following steps describe the SCSI 9-track tape device degrowth procedure:
1. At the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY), inhibit automatic maintenance requests
by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing the ECD using either the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode
(Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the command
mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
3.3. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
3.7. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DFC under which the MT device is
found.
3.9. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the form_type: attribute.
3.12. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
4. At the MTTY, request hard copies from the ROP by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
5. At the MTTY, remove the 9-track tape device by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:MT=a;
If PDS, RMV:MT a!
6.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
7.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
7.5. Enter MT
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
7.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the 9-track tape device being degrown.
7.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
7.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
7.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
8.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
To disconnect the MT, remove the SBUS to which the MT is connected. Refer
to Common Processor Display Page (CPDP) 120 (DFC status page) to
determine the SBUS to be removed.
NOTE:
Do not continue until all mate MHDs have been verified.
10. At the MTTY, remove the SBUS by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:SBUS=a;
If PDS, RMV:SBUS a!
Where: a = unit number of the SBUS from which the 9-track tape device is
being removed.
NOTE 1:
If the 9-track tape device is to be used as an alternative MT device,
it will have to be grown back into the system. Refer to Chapter 20,
‘‘SCSI Peripheral Growth,’’ for the procedure for growing the
9-track device.
NOTE 2:
If the unit is to be physically removed from the system, seek the
assistance of installation technicians after this procedure is
completed.
12. Determine the PLU and the Next Logical Unit (NLU) by referring to the ROP output
obtained in Step 4.
13.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
14. Update the PLU UCB side pointer to bypass the 9-track tape device.
14.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
14.5. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
14.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
14.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
14.8. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
14.9. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the NLU (see the ROP output from
Step 5) or ’ if the 9-track tape device is the last device.
14.10. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
14.11. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the NLU or ’ if the 9-track tape device
is the last device.
14.13. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
15.3. Enter MT
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
15.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the MT.
15.5. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.6. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
15.7. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.8. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
15.9. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.10. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
15.11. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.12. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
15.13. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.15. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
16.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
17. At the MTTY, restore the SBUS to service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RST:SBUS=a;
If PDS, RST:SBUS a!
NOTE:
Do not continue until all units have been restored.
18.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
You must now delete the ECD records for the 9-track tape device. This involves
deleting the logdev records associated with the 9-track tape device first, followed by
the mdct record, and the remaining records as specified in the following steps.
Removing the records in this order prevents ‘‘outstanding reference’’ database errors.
19. Delete each logdev record associated with the 9-track tape device being degrown.
The following is a list of ‘‘base’’ logical device names (logdev records) associated
with the 9-track tape device. Additional logdev records may have been added; refer
to the ROP output obtained in Step 4 for the list of all the logdev records associated
with the MT device being degrown.
/dev/mtx0
/dev/mtx4
/dev/mtx8
/dev/mtxc
/dev/mtxvl0
/dev/mtxvl0n
/dev/mtxvh0
/dev/mtxvh0n
/dev/mtxvl12
/dev/mtxvl12n
/dev/mtxvh12
/dev/mtxvh12n.
NOTE:
The x in each logical device name refers to the unit number of the MT device.
For example, if MT 0 is being degrown, the logical device names would look
like /dev/mt00, /dev/mt04, and so forth and MT 1 would look like
/dev/mt10, /dev/mt14, and so forth.
Refer to 254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual, for additional information
on logdev records.
19.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the logical_name: attribute.
19.3. Enter the logdev record name specified in Step 19 or by the ROP
output obtained in Step 4.
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Delete, Validate, screen#, or Print:
19.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the logical_name: attribute.
19.6. Repeat this subprocedure for each logdev record associated with the
9-track tape device.
20. Delete the mdct records associated with the 9-track tape device.
20.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
20.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
21. Delete the unit control block (ucb) records associated with the 9-track tape device.
21.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
21.5. Enter MT
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
21.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the 9-track tape device being degrown.
21.7. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... FORM DELETED
Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate, screen#,
or Print:
22.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
23.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
24. Update the ECD for rootdmly by repeating Steps 18 through 22 using rootdmly
instead of incore when invoking the database for low-level mode RC/V (Step 2.1 or
2.2), then continue to Step 25.
NOTE:
Skip Step 25 and proceed to Step 26 if a DAT device is to be grown into the
system to replace the 9-track tape device. In this case, a backup is done as
part of the DAT growth procedure. Otherwise, continue to Step 25 to back up
the primary disk partitions.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
26. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
27. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
19
Contents
Introduction 19-1
Prerequisite Conditions 19-1
References 19-2
Procedure 19-2
19
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow a Small Computer System Interface
(SCSI) Digital Audio Tape (DAT) device from a 3B21D computer system.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
! CAUTION:
This procedure requires a working configured tape drive. Do not start this degrowth
procedure for MT 0 or MT 1 if the other drive is unequipped or faulty.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
The following steps describe the SCSI DAT device degrowth procedure:
1. At the Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY), inhibit automatic maintenance requests
by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, INH:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, INH:DMQ:SRC ALL!
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing the ECD using either the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode
(Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
2.1.4. Enter *
2.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
The following subprocedure provides the Unit Control Block (UCB) linkage for the
SBUS subdevices from which the DAT device will be degrown. Side pointer linkage
from the Previous Logical Unit (PLU) to the DAT device must be updated in Step 14
in order to bypass the DAT device. For use later in this procedure, this step also
provides the UCB pointer list, which shows the forms that must removed and the
Minor Device Chain Table (MDCT) pointer list, which provides the logical device
(logdev) records associated with the DAT device being degrown.
3.3. Enter y
3.7. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DFC under which the MT device is
found.
3.9. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the form_type: attribute.
3.13. Enter MT
Response: The cursor moves to the form_inst_key keyfield4:
attribute.
3.14. Enter aa
Where: aa = unit number of the MT being removed.
3.15. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
3.20. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the form_type: attribute.
3.23. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
4. At the MTTY, request hard copies from the ROP by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
5. At the MTTY, remove the DAT device unit by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:MT=a;
If PDS, RMV:MT a!
6.3. Enter e
7.2. Enter u
7.5. Enter MT
7.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DAT device being degrown.
7.7. Enter c
7.8. Enter 21
7.11. Enter u
8.3. Enter *
NOTE:
To disconnect the MT, remove the SBUS to which the MT is connected. Refer
to Common Processor Display Page (CPDP) 120 (DFC status page) to
determine the SBUS to be removed.
NOTE:
Do not continue until all mate MHDs have been verified.
10. At the MTTY, remove the SBUS by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:SBUS=a;
If PDS, RMV:SBUS a!
Where: a = unit number of the SBUS from which the DAT device is being
removed.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
12. Determine the PLU and the Next Logical Unit (NLU) by referring to the ROP output
obtained in Step 4.
13.3. Enter e
14. Update the PLU UCB side pointer to bypass the DAT device.
14.2. Enter u
14.5. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
14.6. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
14.7. Enter c
14.8. Enter 44
14.9. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the NLU (see the ROP output from
Step 4) or ’ if the DAT device is the last device.
14.10. Enter 45
14.11. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the NLU or ’ if the DAT device is the
last device.
14.13. Enter u
15.3. Enter MT
15.4. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the MT.
15.5. Enter c
15.6. Enter 44
15.7. Enter ’
15.8. Enter 45
15.9. Enter ’
15.10. Enter 49
15.11. Enter ’
15.12. Enter 50
15.13. Enter ’
15.15. Enter u
16.3. Enter *
17. At the MTTY, restore the SBUS to service by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RST:SBUS=a;
If PDS, RST:SBUS a!
NOTE:
Do not continue until all units have been restored.
18.3. Enter e
NOTE:
You must now delete the ECD records for the DAT device. This involves deleting the
logdev records associated with the DAT device first, followed by the minor device
chain table (mdct) record, and the remaining records as specified in the following
steps. Removing records in this order prevents ‘‘outstanding reference’’ database
errors.
19. Delete each logdev record associated with the DAT device being degrown.
The following is a list of ‘‘base’’ logical device names (logdev records). Additional
logdev records may have been added; refer to the ROP output obtained in Step 4
for the list of all the logdev records associated with the MT device being degrown.
/dev/mtx0
/dev/mtx4
/dev/mtx8
/dev/mtxc
/dev/mtxvl0
/dev/mtxvl0n
/dev/mtxvh0
/dev/mtxvh0n
/dev/mtxvl12
/dev/mtxvl12n
/dev/mtxvh12
/dev/mtxvh12n.
NOTE:
The x in each logical device name refers to the unit number of the MT device.
For example, if MT 0 is being degrown, the logical device names would look
like /dev/mt00, /dev/mt04, and so forth and MT 1 would look like /dev/mt10,
/dev/mt14, and so forth.
Refer to 254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual, for additional information
on logdev records.
19.2. Enter d
19.3. Enter the logdev record name as specified in Step 19 or by the ROP
output obtained in Step 4.
19.4. Enter d
19.6. Repeat this subprocedure for each logdev record associated with the
DAT device.
20. Delete the mdct records associated with the DAT device.
20.2. Enter d
20.4. Enter d
21. Delete the scanner and signal distributor block body (scsdbody) records associated
with the DAT device.
21.2. Enter d
Response: The cursor moves to the FIELD1 attribute.
21.3. Enter the first part of the form key of scsdbody from the pointer list of
the MT UCB obtained in Step 4.
Response: The cursor moves to the FIELD2 attribute.
21.4. Enter the second part of the form key of scsdbody from the pointer list
of the MT UCB obtained in Step 4.
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Delete, Validate, screen#, or Print:
21.5. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... FORM DELETED
The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
22. Delete the unit control block (ucb) records associated with the DAT device.
22.2. Enter d
22.5. Enter MT
22.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of the DAT device being degrown.
22.7. Enter d
23.3. Enter *
24.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
25. Update the ECD for rootdmly by repeating Steps 18 through 22 using rootdmly
instead of incore when invoking the database for low-level mode RC/V (Step 2.1 or
2.2), then continue to Step 26.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
27. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
28. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
20
Contents
Introduction 20-1
Prerequisite Conditions 20-1
References 20-2
Hardware Description 20-2
Procedure 20-6
20
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow a Small Computer System Interface
(SCSI) Moving Head Disk (MHD), a pair of duplex SCSI MHDs, a SCSI Digital Audio Tape
(DAT) device, or a SCSI 9-track tape device into a 3B21D computer system. The SCSI
MHD, the SCSI DAT device, and the SCSI 9-track tape device are collectively referred to as
SCSI Peripheral Units (SPUs).
The SPUs are grown using the addition of scsi (scsiadd) high-level form. Detailed
information about the form fields can be found in 254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify
Manual. Accessing the form, adding correct data, and starting execution causes messages
to be displayed on the terminal screen. The messages request you to diagnose, restore,
power up, remove power, or connect the hardware.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the CU, DFCs, Input/Output
Processors (IOPs), MHDs, and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
The growth shelf where the SPU will be installed must be grown. If the SPU to be
installed is a 9-track tape device, the growth cabinet should have already been
installed.
The Scanner and Signal Distributor Controller (SCSDC) pack needed for the
Scanner and Signal Distributor (SCSD) points for the SPU being installed (not
needed for the 9-track tape devices) must be installed and active.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-105, Hardware Reference Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Common Systems Specification for 3B21D Computer System, J3T061A-1.
Hardware Description
The SCSI is a defined standard for attaching input/output peripherals to host computers.
Components that make up the SCSI community are a SCSI Bus (SBUS), devices which
attach to the SBUS, and a host adapter. The host adapter attaches the SBUS to the host
computer.
The 3B21D computer supports either one or two pairs of the SCSI Disk File Controllers
(DFCs) that are the SCSI host adapters. Each SCSI DFC is equipped with two SBUSs
supporting up to seven SPUs per bus. Duplex MHDs are grown on the DFCs belonging to
different Control Units (CUs). The SCSI DFCs are attached to the 3B21D computer via the
Dual Serial Channels (DSCHs).
The SCSI MHD and DAT device are available as circuit boards. The SCSI MHD or the DAT
device occupy two Peripheral Controller (PC) slots in the processor cabinet. The 9-track
tape device is a vertically mounted unit and is installed in the growth cabinet and connected
to the SBUS.
Note that the 9-track tape device does not need SCSD points. The assignments and
locations for SCSDC packs for all SPUs (except 9-track tape devices) are given in
Table 20-1. The SCSDC0 and SCSDC1 are always equipped in all offices, so the SCSD
points for SPUs 2 through 5 and SPU 54 are always available. However, when growing an
SPU 18 through 27, SCSDC16 is needed. If SCSDC16 does not exist on the system and is
needed, it must to be grown and made active.
The J3T061A-1 drawing illustrates the locations of the SPUs in the processor cabinet in the
small and large office. The 9-track tape device is located in a growth cabinet as illustrated
by the J3T061A-1 drawing. The SPU numbers shown in the J3T061A-1 drawing
correspond to those in Table 20-1. The J3T061A-1 drawing needs to be used in
conjunction with Table 20-1 to get the Equipment Location (EQL) numbers that correspond
to the SPU positions.
Table 20-1. 3B21D Computer SPU Configurations and SCSD Assignment Rules
Table 20-1. 3B21D Computer SPU Configurations and SCSD Assignment Rules (Contd)
Procedure
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
NOTE:
For the DAT device, do not seat the circuit pack. For the MHDs
and 9-track devices, the ON/OFF switch should be in the OFF
position.
3. Invoke the incore database high-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing the ECD using either the menu mode (Step 3.1) or the command mode
(Step 3.2).
NOTE:
If an MHD or DAT device is being grown, the selected RC/V terminal must not
be connected to the IOP from which power is to be removed in Step 19. Refer
to Table 20-1 to determine which IOP to remove power for the SPU number
corresponding to the MHD/DAT device being installed. From this point on, this
procedure refers to the selected terminal as the RC/V terminal.
3.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
3.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
3.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
5. Enter scsiadd
Response: The system displays a blank scsiadd form.
The cursor moves to attribute 1.
6. Enter the values for the SPU being grown. These values are provided by the
equipment supplier to the installers. Refer to Table 20-1 in this procedure.
NOTE 1:
If growing a duplex MHD (those numbered 2 through 13), first grow the even-
numbered MHD as a simplex unit, and then grow the odd-numbered MHD as a
duplex unit.
NOTE 2:
If growing an even-numbered MHD, the disk_option field (field 9) of the
scsiadd form must be set to 0 and the duplex_mhd_num field (field 8) must be
null.
7. Enter i
Response: The system begins to make changes to the ECD in response to
the data on the form. A transaction block is executed to add the
unit control block (ucb), minor device chain table (mdct), and
logical device (logdev) records.
8. Determine if the type_drive field on the high-level scsiadd form equals 9TRK.
If yes, go to Step 31.
If no, continue to Step 9.
9. The system prompts you to the port switch the MTTY and the ROP if they are
connected to the IOP that will be powered off in Step 19. Refer to Table 20-1 to
determine which IOP will be powered down. (Table 20-1 provides a correspondence
between the SPU number, the SCSDC number, and the IOP number.)
10. Determine if the MTTY is connected to the IOP that will be powered off in Step 19.
If yes, continue to Step 11.
If no, go to Step 13.
11. Verify that the port switches, located at the bottom of the processor cabinet, are both
in the AUTO position.
12. Switch the MTTY to another IOP by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW:DATA,MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:DATA,MTTY!
13. Determine if the ROP is connected to the IOP that will be powered off in Step 19.
If yes, continue to Step 14.
If no, go to Step 16.
14. Verify that the port switches, located at the bottom of the processor cabinet, are both
in the AUTO position.
15. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to another IOP by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW:DATA,ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
18. At the Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS) of the IOP removed in Step 17,
verify that the OOS Light-Emitting Diode (LED) is lighted.
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has been successfully completed.
19. At IOPPS TN1820, remove power from the IOP by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch
to the OFF position. At the MTTY, monitor the progress by watching Common
Processor Display Page (CPDP) 102.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP a
20. Verify that the OFF LED lights and that the ALM LED flashes.
21. Press the <CR> key.
Response: The system prompts you to connect the scan cables from the
SPU to the SCSDC.
22. Connect the SPU scan cables to the appropriate locations on the associated
SCSDC.
23. Press the <CR> key.
Response: The system continues to make changes to the ECD, the scanner
and signal distributor option block body (scsdbody) form is
inserted, and the system prompts you to power up and restore
the IOP that was removed in Step 17.
24. At IOPPS TN1820, restore power to the IOP by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to
the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
NOTE:
The IOP and all units controlled by it are restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. At the MTTY, monitor the progress
by watching CPDP 102.
27. Determine if the MTTY and the ROP should be switched to the restored IOP.
If yes, continue to Step 28.
If no, go to Step 31.
28. Verify that the port switches, located at the bottom of the processor cabinet, are both
in the AUTO position.
29. Switch the MTTY to the original IOP by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW:DATA,MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:MTTY!
30. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to the original IOP by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW:DATA,ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:ROP!
31. If the SPU being installed is either a DAT device or an MHD, press the <CR> key at
the RC/V terminal.
NOTE:
If the SPU being installed is a 9-track tape device, you will see a response
without pressing the <CR> key. The system displays executing trend... and
prompts you that the next step will be to remove the SBUS (on which the SPU
is being grown) from service.
32. At the MTTY, use CPDP 121 to identify all duplex nongrowth MHDs located on the
SBUS where the SPU is being grown.
33. Determine the mate for each MHD identified in Step 32.
34. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key.
Response: The system prompts you to verify all mate MHDs that were
determined in the previous step.
NOTE:
Do not continue until all mate MHDs have been verified.
Where: a = controlling SBUS for the SPU being installed (see Table 20-1).
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has been successfully completed.
38. Verify that the OOS LEDs on the MHDs and MTs are controlled by the selected
SBUS lights.
39. Set the Identification (ID) of the SPU to the value specified in the high-level form
device_id field.
40. Set the ROS/RST switch to the ROS position on the MHD device.
NOTE:
To connect the SPU to the SBUS, a SCSI jumper cable is needed. If the SPU
is in location 2, 3, 18, or 19 (only SPUs can be grown in these locations; PCs
cannot be grown in these locations), the SCSI jumper is not needed. Refer to
Table 20-2.
44. The system prompts you to restore the SBUS controller corresponding to the SPU
being installed by entering the appropriate input command at the MTTY.
If MML, RST:SBUS=a:DATA,CONT;
If PDS, RST:SBUS a:CONT!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
NOTE:
If the SPU being installed is an MHD, do not restore this SPU.
55. End the DAT device or 9-track tape device growth procedure.
56.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
58. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
59. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
21
Contents
Introduction 21-1
Prerequisite Conditions 21-1
References 21-2
Procedure 21-2
21
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow the Scanner and Signal Distributor
Controller 16 (SCSDC16) (UN33/UN933). The SCSDC16 must be grown and active before
growing the Small Computer System Interface (SCSI) Peripheral Units (SPUs) 18 through
27 into a 3B21D computer system. The procedure for growing SPUs 18 through 27 is
found in Chapter 20, ‘‘SCSI Peripheral Growth.’’
The SCSDC growth procedure is used for all other growth SCSDC circuit packs. Refer to
Chapter 17, ‘‘SCSDC Growth,’’ for the specific procedure.
NOTE:
UN33/UN933 circuit packs cannot be mixed in an office.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the past 48 hours
and should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU),
Disk File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
2. Invoke the incore database high-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V) by
accessing the ECD using either the menu mode (Step 2.1) or the command mode
(Step 2.2).
2.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
NOTE:
The selected terminal must not be connected to IOP 0 when it is
powered down. From this point on, this procedure refers to the
selected terminal as the RC/V terminal. Follow local practices to
notify other users of IOP 0 that the IOP will be powered down
during the growth procedure.
3. Determine the Previous Logical Unit (PLU) and the Next Logical Unit (NLU) to
SCSDC16.
3.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the Enter Review, Validate, or
Print: attribute.
NOTE:
The pc (in link order) attribute displays the Unit Control Block
(UCB) linkage for IOP 0 subdevices. Examine the unitname and
unitnumber attributes under the unitname and unitnumber
columns, and determine which unit is the PLU to SCSDC16 and
which is the NLU to SCSDC16. It is important to note that the PLU
will be removed from service. Note the unitname and unitnumber
attributes for the PLU and NLU for later use.
3.5. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
4. Insert the unit control block (ucb), minor device chain table (mdct), and scanner and
signal distributor option block head (scsdopt) records.
4.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes executing... FORM EXECUTED
once and then displays Enter Form Name:
4.5. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
4.9. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Change-insert, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
4.10. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.11. Enter 4
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
4.12. Enter 16
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.13. Enter 13
Response: The cursor moves to the internal_device attribute.
4.14. Enter 12
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.15. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
4.17. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
4.18. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.19. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
4.20. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.21. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
4.22. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.23. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
4.24. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.25. Enter 57
Response: The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
4.27. Enter 58
Response: The cursor moves to the pcid: attribute.
4.28. Enter 12
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.30. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate, screen#,
or Print:
4.33. Enter r
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name: attribute.
4.35. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.36. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_name attribute.
4.38. Enter 4
Response: The cursor moves to the mdct_id_char: attribute.
4.39. Enter 2
Response: The system displays Change Field:
4.40. Enter 9
Response: The system displays row:
4.41. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the
active_devices.unit_number: attribute.
4.42. Enter 16
Response: The system displays row:
4.45. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
Enter Review, Change-insert, Validate, screen#,
or Print:
4.48. Enter i
Response: The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
4.50. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting... FORM INSERTED
The cursor moves to the option_name: attribute.
4.54. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
5. At the MTTY, remove the PLU from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:a=b;
If PDS, RMV:a b!
NOTE:
The PLU name and number were obtained in Step 3.
6.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes executing... FORM EXECUTED
once and then displays Enter Form Name:
6.5. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
6.8. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
NOTE:
The PLU name was obtained from Step 3.
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
6.9. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
NOTE:
The PLU number was obtained from Step 3.
6.10. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
6.11. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
6.13. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
6.14. Enter 16
Response: The system displays Change Field:
6.16. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
7.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
7.6. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
7.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
7.9. Enter 44
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
7.10. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU
(that is, the SCSDC16 is at the end of the chain).
7.11. Enter 45
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
7.12. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the NLU or ’ if there is no NLU
(that is, the SCSDC16 is at the end of the chain).
7.13. Enter 49
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_name:
attribute.
7.15. Enter 50
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 unit_number:
attribute.
7.16. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
7.18. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
7.22. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
8.2. Verify that the port switches, located at the bottom of the processor
cabinet, are both in the AUTO position.
8.3. Switch the MTTY to another IOP by entering the appropriate input
command on the MTTY:
If MML, SW:PORTSW:DATA,MTTY;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:DATA,MTTY!
8.5. Verify that the port switches, located at the bottom of the processor
cabinet, are both in the AUTO position.
8.6. At the MTTY, switch the ROP to another IOP by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, SW:PORTSW:DATA,ROP;
If PDS, SW:PORTSW:DATA,ROP!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to
prevent damage to components.
8.9. Insert the SCSDC circuit pack at Equipment Location (EQL) 28-130.
9.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
9.5. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
9.9. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
9.10. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
9.11. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
9.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
9.18. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
10. At the MTTY, diagnose SCSDC16 by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, DGN:SCSDC=a,RAW,TLP;
If PDS, DGN:SCSDC a,RAW,TLP!
NOTE:
Do not continue until this request has successfully completed.
11.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
11.5. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
11.9. Enter 16
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
11.10. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
11.11. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
11.14. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating... FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
11.18. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
12. At MTTY CPDP 121, verify that SCSDC16 is displayed in the OOS state.
14.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
16. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
22
Contents
Introduction 22-1
Prerequisite Conditions 22-1
References 22-2
Procedure 22-2
22
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow a Synchronous Data Link (SDL) from
a 3B21D computer system via high-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V).
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the 3B21D computer system before starting this
degrowth procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On the equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the past 48 hours
and should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU),
Disk File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2.3. Enter the unit_name and unit_number values for the link being degrown
as provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading... Please wait...
followed by Enter Insert, Change, Substitute,
Validate, or Print:
2.4. Enter d
Response: The system indicates Deleting.... and prompts you
to remove the IOP controlling the SDL.
3. At the MTTY, remove from service the IOP from which the SDL is being degrown by
entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=a;
If PDS, RMV:IOP a!
NOTE:
At Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS) TN1820, the OOS and the
ROS Light-Emitting Diodes (LEDs) light.
! CAUTION:
The system may sustain a severe maintenance reset if the mate unit is
unavailable.
5. At Out-of-Service (OOS) IOPPS TN1820, remove power from IOP a by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP a
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED lights.
6. Remove the cable from the SDL Controller (SDLC) and the data set (SDL).
NOTE:
Seek technical assistance from installation engineers if necessary.
NOTE 1:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED at IOP a extinguishes.
NOTE 2:
IOP a and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching the
Common Processor Display Page (CPDP).
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED IOP a
followed by RST IOP a COMPLETED followed by RST...
COMPLETED for each unit under IOP a.
10. At IOPPS TN1820, restore OOS IOP a to service via frame controls by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the RST position.
Response: The system displays RST IOP a COMPLETED
At IOPPS TN1820, the OOS and RQIP LEDs extinguish.
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the green LED lights and diagnostics on the IOP
automatically start.
12.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
14. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
23
Contents
Introduction 23-1
Prerequisite Conditions 23-1
References 23-2
Procedure 23-2
23
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow Synchronous Data Links (SDLs) into a
3B21D computer system via high-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V). The SDLs
are grown using the addition of synchronous data link (sdladd) form. Detailed information
about the form fields that need to be populated can be found in 254-303-104, Recent
Change and Verify Manual.
Accessing the sdladd form, adding correct data, and starting execution causes messages to
be displayed on the terminal screen. The messages request you to diagnose, restore,
power up, remove power, or connect hardware.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
The following steps describe the SDL growth procedure:
1. Invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 1.1) or the command mode (Step 1.2).
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2.3. Enter the unit_name and unit_number values for the link being grown as
provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading... Please Wait...
prompts for each field value and displays Enter
Insert, Change, Substitute, Validate, or Print:
2.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting...
NOTE:
The system begins to make changes to the incore ECD in
response to the data input on the sdladd form. Messages flash on
the screen indicating the activity currently in progress.
3. At the MTTY, remove the IOP controlling the SDL from service by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=a;
If PDS, RMV:IOP a!
4. At Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS) TN1820, remove power from IOP
a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
5. At IOPPS TN1820, verify that the red OFF Light-Emitting Diode (LED) lights.
7. Connect the SDL cable to the appropriate location on the associated SDLC.
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the red OFF LED extinguishes, the green LED lights, and
diagnostics on IOP a automatically start. Do not continue until the IOP is
restored.
11. At the MTTY, remove the SDLC from service (the controller to which the link is to be
added) by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:SDLC=a;
If PDS, RMV:SDLC a!
13. At the MTTY, restore the SDLC (to which the link is added) to service by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:SDLC=a;
If PDS, RST:SDLC a!
15. Restore the SDL to service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:SDL=a;
If PDS, RST:SDL a!
16.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
18. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
24
Contents
Introduction 24-1
Prerequisite Conditions 24-1
References 24-2
Procedure 24-2
24
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow a Synchronous Data Link Controller
(SDLC) from a 3B21D computer system via high-level mode Recent Change and Verify
(RC/V).
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run recently within the past 48
hours and should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit
(CU), Disk File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head
Disks (MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2.3. Enter y
2.6. Enter CU
2.7. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of CU 0 or 1.
NOTE:
The ucb_list provides a list of all subdevices under the CU.
2.8. Enter *
3. At the MTTY, request hard copies from the Receive-Only Printer (ROP) by entering
the appropriate input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
NOTE:
All subdevices under the SDLC must be deleted before continuing. If the
controller is a TN75C or a TN1839 circuit pack, two ports are supported and the
deletion of two subdevices may be required. If the controller is a UN582 circuit
pack, four ports are supported and the deletion of four subdevices may be
required. Refer to Chapter 22, ‘‘SDL Degrowth,’’ for the procedure.
5.3. Enter the unit_name and unit_number values for the controller being
degrown as provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading… Please wait…
prompts for each field value and then displays Enter
Delete, Validate, or Print:
5.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting... in the upper right
corner of the screen and prompts you to remove
power from the IOP controlling the SDLC.
6. At the Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS), remove the IOP that is to lose
the SDLC from service by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=a;
If PDS, RMV:IOP a!
NOTE:
At IOPPS, the OOS and ROS Light-Emitting Diodes (LEDs) light.
! CAUTION:
The system may sustain a severe maintenance reset if the mate unit is
unavailable.
7. At the Out-of-Service (OOS) IOPPS TN1820, remove power from IOP a by operating
the ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED IOP a
NOTE:
At the IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED lights.
8. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key to continue the high-level degrowth
process.
Response: The system prompts you to remove the SDLC.
10. At the RC/V terminal, press the <CR> key to continue the high-level degrowth
process.
Response: The system displays the actions currently in progress.
12. At IOPPS TN1820, restore power to IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to
the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
NOTE 1:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED extinguishes.
NOTE 2:
IOP a and all units controlled by it will be restored automatically because the
ROS/RST switch is in the RST position. Monitor the progress by watching
the Common Processor Display Page (CPDP).
13. At IOPPS TN1820, restore IOP a to service via frame controls by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the RST position.
Response: The system displays RST IOP a COMPLETED
At the IOPPS TN1820, the OOS and RQIP LEDs extinguish.
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the green LED lights and diagnostics on the IOP
automatically start.
15.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
17. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
25
Contents
Introduction 25-1
Prerequisite Conditions 25-1
References 25-2
Procedure 25-2
25
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow Synchronous Data Link Controllers
(SDLCs) into a 3B21D computer system. The SDLCs are grown using the addition of
synchronous data link controller (sdlcadd) form. Detailed information about the form fields
that need to be populated can be found in 254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual.
Accessing the sdlcadd form, adding correct data, and starting execution causes messages
to be displayed on the terminal screen. The messages request you to diagnose, restore,
power up, remove power, or connect hardware.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist before starting this growth procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run recently within the past 48
hours and should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit
(CU), Disk File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head
Disks (MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.2. At the MTTY, access the ECD using the command mode by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2.3. Enter the unit_name and the unit_number values for the controller pack
being grown as provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading… Please wait…
prompts for each field value and then displays Enter
Insert, Change, Substitute, Validate, or Print:
2.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting...
NOTE:
The system begins to make changes to the incore ECD in
response to the data input on the sdlcadd form. Messages flash
on the screen indicating the activities currently in progress.
3. At the MTTY, remove the IOP controlling the SDLC from service by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=a;
If PDS, RMV:IOP a!
4. At Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS) TN1820, remove power from IOP
a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
5. At IOPPS TN1820, verify that the red OFF Light-Emitting Diode (LED) lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
7. Install the required SDLC circuit pack by lining up the top and the bottom of the pack
with the card guides and sliding the pack into position with the latch at the lower end
of the faceplate open. When the circuit pack begins to make contact with the
backplane pins (this will be felt by increased resistance while inserting the pack), the
bottom of the latch should make contact with the bottom of the unit assembly. Close
the latch to push the pack into the final position.
10. At IOPPS TN1820, verify that the red OFF LED extinguishes.
Response: The system displays RST IOP a COMPLETED
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the green LED lights and diagnostics on IOP a
automatically start. Do not continue until the IOP is restored.
12. At the MTTY, restore the growth SDLC to service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RST:SDLC=a;
If PDS, RST:SDLC a!
13.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
15. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
26
Contents
Introduction 26-1
Prerequisite Conditions 26-1
References 26-2
Procedure 26-2
26
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow the Teletypewriter (TTY) from a
3B21D computer system.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the past 48 hours
and should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU),
Disk File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2.3. Enter the unit_name and unit_number values for the link being degrown
as provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading... Please wait...
followed by Enter Insert, Change, Substitute,
Validate, or Print:
2.4. Enter d
Response: The system indicates Deleting.... and prompts you
to remove the IOP controlling the Synchronous Data
Link (SDL).
3. At the MTTY, remove IOP a from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=a ;
If PDS, RMV:IOP a !
Response: The system removes all subunits from service and displays RMV
IOP a COMPLETED
At Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS) TN1820, the
OOS and ROS Light-Emitting Diodes (LEDs) light.
! CAUTION:
The system may sustain a severe maintenance reset if the mate unit is
unavailable.
5. At IOPPS TN1820, remove power from IOP a by operating the ST/ON/OFF switch
to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
6. Remove the cable connecting the TTY Controller (TTYC) to the TTY.
NOTE:
Wait for the system to display the REPT DEGROWTH TTY a COMPLETED
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OOS LED lights.
9. At IOPPS TN1820, restore IOP a to service via frame controls by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the RST position.
Response: The system restores all subunits to service and displays
RST COMPLETED
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OOS and RQIP LEDs extinguish.
11.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
13. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
27
Contents
Introduction 27-1
Prerequisite Conditions 27-1
References 27-2
Procedure 27-2
27
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow the Teletypewriter (TTY) into a 3B21D
computer system. The TTY is grown using the addition of teletypewriter (ttyadd) form.
Accessing the ttyadd form, adding correct data, and starting execution causes messages to
be displayed on the terminal screen. The messages request you to diagnose, restore,
power up, remove power, or connect hardware.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the last 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V using
the command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2.3. Enter the unit_name and the unit_number values for the TTY being
grown as provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading… Please wait…
prompts for each field value and displays Enter
Insert, Change, Substitute, Validate, or Print:
2.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting...
NOTE:
The system begins to make changes to the incore ECD in
response to the data input on the ttyadd form. The system
flashes messages on the screen indicating the activities currently in
progress. The system prompts you to remove IOP a from service.
5. At IOPPS TN1820, verify that the red OFF Light-Emitting Diode (LED) lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
NOTE:
If the TTYC is a UN582 circuit pack and the TTY is being grown on port 2 of the
TTYC, special cabling is required to connect the TTY to the TTYC.
The pin Equipment Locations (EQLs) for the TTY ports are listed as follows:
pin EQL 132 - port 0
pin EQL 332 - port 1
pin EQL 532 - port 2 (requires special cable)
pin EQL 500 - port 3.
10. At IOPPS TN1820, verify that the red OFF LED extinguishes.
Response: The system displays RST IOP a COMPLETED
NOTE:
At the IOPPS TN1820, the green LED lights and diagnostics on IOP a
automatically start. Do not continue until the IOP and all subunits are restored.
12. At the MTTY, remove the TTYC to which the TTY is added from service by entering
the appropriate input command.
If MML, RMV:TTYC=a ;
If PDS, RMV:TTYC a !
14. At the MTTY, restore the TTYC to which the TTY is added to service by entering the
appropriate input command.
If MML, RST:TTYC=a ;
If PDS, RST:TTYC a !
16.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
18. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
28
Contents
Introduction 28-1
Prerequisite Conditions 28-1
References 28-2
Procedure 28-2
28
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow a Teletypewriter Controller (TTYC)
from a 3B21D computer system via high-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V).
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the past 48 hours and
should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU), Disk
File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks (MHDs),
and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the incore
ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2. Obtain the Unit Control Block (UCB) listing to determine TTYC subdevices.
2.3. Enter y
2.6. Enter CU
2.7. Enter a
Where: a = unit number of CU 0 or 1.
NOTE:
The ucb_list provides a list of all subdevices under the CU.
2.8. Type *
3. At the MTTY, request hard copies of the form from the Receive-Only Printer (ROP)
by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:FN="/tmp/filename",ALL;
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:FN "/tmp/filename",ALL!
NOTE:
All subdevices under the TTYC must be deleted before continuing. If the
controller is a TN74B circuit pack, two ports are supported and the deletion of
two subdevices may be required. If the controller is a UN582 circuit pack, four
ports are supported and the deletion of four subdevices may be required. Refer
to Chapter 26, ‘‘TTY Degrowth,’’ for the TTY degrowth procedure.
5.2. Access the high-level deletion form for TTYC degrowth by entering
ttycdel
Response: The system displays a blank deletion of teletypewriter
controller (ttycdel) form.
5.3. Enter unit_name and unit_number values for TTYC being degrown.
Response: The system displays Reading… Please wait…
followed by Enter Delete, Validate, or Print
5.4. Enter d
Response: The system displays Deleting… in the upper right
of the screen and prompts you to remove and power
down the IOP.
6. At the MTTY, remove the IOP from service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RMV:IOP=a ;
If PDS, RMV:IOP a !
Response: The system removes all subunits from service before displaying
the RMV IOP a COMPLETED message.
At the Input/Output Processor Power Switch (IOPPS) TN1820,
the OOS and the ROS Light-Emitting Diodes (LEDs) light.
! CAUTION:
The system may sustain a severe maintenance reset if the mate unit is
unavailable.
7. At the Out-of-Service (OOS) IOPPS TN1820, remove power from IOP a by operating
the ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OFF LED lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
11. At IOPPS TN1820 of the powered down IOP, restore power to IOP a by operating
the ST/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OOS LED lights.
12. At IOPPS TN1820, restore IOP a to service via frame controls by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the RST position.
Response: The system restores all subunits to service and displays RST
COMPLETED
NOTE:
At IOPPS TN1820, the OOS and RQIP LEDs extinguish.
14.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
16. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
29
Contents
Introduction 29-1
Prerequisite Conditions 29-1
References 29-2
Procedure 29-2
29
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow the Teletypewriter Controller (TTYC)
into a 3B21D computer system via high-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V).
The TTYC is grown using the addition of teletypewriter controller (ttycadd) form. Detailed
information about the form fields that need to be populated can be found in 254-303-104,
Recent Change and Verify Manual.
Accessing the ttycadd form, adding correct data, and starting execution causes messages
to be displayed on the terminal screen. The messages request you to diagnose, restore,
power up, remove power, or connect hardware.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
All 3B21D computer hardware should be either active or standby.
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
On all equipped units, diagnostics should have been run within the past 48 hours
and should have yielded an All Tests Passed (ATP) result on the Control Unit (CU),
Disk File Controllers (DFCs), Input/Output Processors (IOPs), Moving Head Disks
(MHDs), and Magnetic Tape (MT).
Ensure that within the past 24 hours the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this growth
procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
1.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
1.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
1.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database high-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
2.3. Enter the unit_name and the unit_number values for the controller pack
being grown as provided by application engineering.
Response: The system displays Reading… Please wait…
prompts for each field value and then displays Enter
Insert, Change, Substitute, Validate, or Print:
2.4. Enter i
Response: The system displays Inserting...
NOTE:
The system begins to make changes to the incore ECD in
response to the data input on the ttycadd form. Messages flash
on the screen indicating the activities currently in progress. The
system prompts you to remove power from IOP a.
5. At IOPPS TN1820, verify that the red OFF Light-Emitting Diode (LED) lights.
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuits packs to prevent damage
to components.
7. Install the required TTYC circuit pack by lining up the top and bottom of the pack with
the card guides and sliding the pack into position with the latch at the lower end of
the faceplate open. When the circuit pack begins to make contact with the
backplane pins (this will be felt by increased resistance while inserting the pack), the
bottom of the latch should make contact with the bottom of the unit assembly. Close
the latch to push the pack into the final position.
10. At IOPPS TN1820, verify that the red OFF LED extinguishes.
Response: The system displays RST IOP a COMPLETED
NOTE 1:
At the IOPPS TN1820, the green LED lights and diagnostics on IOP a
automatically start.
NOTE 2:
Do not continue until the IOP and all subunits are restored.
12. At the MTTY, restore the growth TTYC to service by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, RST:TTYC=a ;
If PDS, RST:TTYC a !
13.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
15. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
30
Contents
Introduction 30-1
Prerequisite Conditions 30-1
References 30-2
Procedure 30-2
30
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to degrow a UN379 Utility Circuit (UC) from a
3B21D computer system via low-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V). The UC
pack is used for debugging purposes. Therefore, the removal of the unit control block (ucb)
forms which will allow the UN379 UC pack to be regrown quickly is not contained in this
procedure.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this degrowth
procedure:
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
Ensure that the disks and the Input/Output Processors (IOPs) are in duplex and that
the Control Units (CUs) have been in the active-standby mode (with the exception of
the routine maintenance and diagnostic request).
Ensure that diagnostics on both CUs have been run to successful completion within
24 hours prior to start of this procedure (UC degrowth).
Ensure that all computer and/or system problems have been cleared before
degrowth activity begins.
Ensure that within the past 24 hours, the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available for reference during this
degrowth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
NOTE:
At the Receive-Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL ACTIVE
3. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821 [at Equipment Location (EQL)
53-060], remove CU 1 from service by operating the ROS/RST switch to the ROS
position.
NOTE:
Step 3 prevents automatic restoral of the CU 1 when the unit is powered up
later in this procedure.
4. Force CU 0 on-line.
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 1 displays a Force Off-Line (FOFL) indicator and
CU 0 displays a Force On-Line (FONL) indicator.
4.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
5. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 5.1) or the command mode (Step 5.2).
5.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
5.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
5.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
6.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
7.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
7.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
7.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
7.5. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
7.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
7.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
7.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
7.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
8.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
10. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), remove power from CU 1 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
NOTE:
If not supplied, a blank faceplate should be ordered.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
12.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then to extinguish before
continuing to Step 13.2.
13.3. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 1 in progress and wait until CU 1 is restored to standby before
continuing.
15. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove CU 0 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then to extinguish before continuing to
Step 16.
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 0 displays an FOFL indicator and CU 1 displays
an FONL indicator.
16.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
17. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 17.1) or the command mode (Step 17.2).
17.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
17.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
17.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode via the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
18.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
19.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
19.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
19.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
19.5. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
19.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Update, Change, Substitute,
Validate, screen#, or Print:
19.7. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
19.8. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
19.11. Enter u
Response: The system displays updating… FORM UPDATED
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name
attribute.
20.3. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing… FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
22. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove power from CU 0 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 0
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage
to components.
NOTE:
If not supplied, a blank faceplate should be ordered.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
24.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
NOTE:
Wait for the RQIP light to come on and then to extinguish before
continuing to Step 25.2.
25.3. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 0 in progress and wait until CU 0 is restored to standby before
continuing.
26. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 26.1) or the command mode (Step 26.2).
26.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
26.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
26.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V via the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
27.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
29. Update the ECD for rootdmly by repeating Steps 5 through 9 and Steps 17
through 21 using rootdmly instead of the incore database when preparing the ECD
RC/V terminal, then continue to Step 30.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
31. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command:
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
32. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
31
Contents
Introduction 31-1
Prerequisite Conditions 31-1
References 31-2
Procedure 31-2
31
Introduction
This chapter describes the procedure used to grow a UN379 Utility Circuit (UC) into a
3B21D computer system via low-level mode Recent Change and Verify (RC/V). The UC
pack is used for debugging purposes. This procedure supports the unequipped
configuration. Key field information that is to be provided by application engineering is
required in this procedure.
Prerequisite Conditions
The following initial conditions must exist in the system before starting this growth
procedure:
No system update activity should be taking place when performing this procedure.
Ensure that the disks and the Input/Output Processors (IOPs) are in duplex and that
Control Units (CUs) have been in the active-standby mode (with the exception of
routine maintenance and diagnostic request).
Ensure that diagnostics on both CUs have been run to successful completion within
24 hours prior to start of this procedure (UC growth).
Ensure that all computer and/or system problems have been cleared before growth
activity begins.
Ensure that within the past 24 hours, the 3B21D computer has not experienced any
terminal suspends, bootstraps, diagnostic failures, or overloads.
The root Equipment Configuration Database (ECD) must be consistent with the
incore ECD.
References
The following Information Products (IPs) must be available during this growth procedure:
254-303-104, Recent Change and Verify Manual
254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
Procedure
NOTE:
At the Receive Only Printer (ROP), the following response will periodically
appear: REPT DMQ INHIBIT ALL
2. Verify that the UC unit control block (ucb) form is in the database as unequipped or
determine Unit Control Block (UCB) linkage if UC is to be grown.
The following subprocedure verifies if the ucb form for the UC is already in the
database as unequipped and provides a UCB linkage list needed to update the
Previous Logical Unit (PLU) and the Next Logical Unit (NLU) if UC is being grown.
2.2. At the MTTY, ensure that the terminal is in the command mode.
2.7. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
2.10. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.12. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
2.13. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
2.14. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
2.15. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.16. Enter p
Response: The system flashes Form Printed: in the upper
right corner of the screen and then displays Enter
Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.18. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
2.19. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
2.20. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
2.21. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form and
displays Enter Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.22. Enter p
Response: The system flashes Form Printed: in the upper
right corner of the screen and then displays Enter
Review, Validate, screen#, or Print:
2.27. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
2.28. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
2.29. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
2.30. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
2.31. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the iop_list: attribute.
2.32. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Enter Review, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
2.33. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.36. Enter y
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
2.37. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_number:
attribute.
2.38. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_name: attribute.
2.39. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the unit_number: attribute.
2.40. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the iop_list: attribute.
2.41. Enter ’
Response: The system displays Enter Review, Validate,
screen#, or Print:
2.42. Enter e
Response: The system flashes executing... FORM EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
2.45. In the previous steps, verify if the UC ucb form was already in the
database as unequipped.
If yes, then go to Step 9.
If no, continue to Step 3.
3. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 3.1) or the command mode (Step 3.2).
3.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
3.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
3.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V using the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
4.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
5.3. Populate all fields of the ucb form except the up, down, and side pointer
linkages with data as provided by application engineering.
5.4. Enter i
Response: The system flashes FORM INSERTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then the display
returns to page 1 of the ucb form.
7.2. Press the <CR> key four times to default all four fields on the trend
form.
7.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
10. At Control Unit Power Switch (CUPS) TN1821 [at Equipment Location (EQL)
53-060], remove CU 1 from service by operating the ROS/RST switch to the ROS
position.
Response: The system displays RMV CU 1 COMPLETED
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 1 displays a Force Off-Line (FOFL) indicator and
CU 0 displays a Force On-Line (FONL) indicator.
11.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
12. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 12.1) or the command mode (Step 12.2).
12.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
12.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
12.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V using the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
13.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
14.3. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
14.4. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
14.5. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
14.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
14.7. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
15. Update the PLU side pointer linkage to point to the growth UC.
15.2. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.3. Enter 41
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
15.4. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
15.5. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
15.6. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
15.7. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
15.9. Enter u
Response: The system flashes FORM UPDATED once in the
upper right corner of the screen.
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
16.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
16.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
16.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
16.5. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
16.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form.
17. Update the UC up pointer linkage to point to Out-of-Service (OOS) CU, and change
major status field from UNEQIP to GROW.
17.2. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
17.4. Enter 46
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
17.7. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
17.8. Enter 1
Response: The system displays Change Field
17.9. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
18.2. Enter 41
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
18.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
18.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
18.5. Enter aa
Where: aa = unit name of the NLU.
18.6. Enter bb
Where: bb = unit number of the NLU.
18.8. Enter u
Response: The system flashes FORM UPDATED once in the
upper right corner of the screen.
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
19.2. Press the <CR> key four times to default all four fields on the trend
form.
19.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
21. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), remove power from CU 1 by operating the
START/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 1
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage
to components.
22. Install the UN379 UC circuit pack (at EQL 45-050). Line up the top and bottom of the
circuit pack with the card guides and slide the pack into position with the latch at the
lower end of the faceplate open. When the circuit pack begins to make contact with
the backplane pins (this will be felt by increased resistance while inserting the pack),
the bottom of the latch should make contact with the bottom of the unit assembly.
Close the latch to push the pack into the final position.
23. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 53-060), restore power to CU 1 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED CU 1
NOTE:
During an RC session, input messages may be used via the CMD MSG
key. Return to the RC session by operating the CMD MSG key twice.
24.2. Verify that the ATP MSG COMPL output message has been received.
NOTE:
Some diagnostics may require up to 30 minutes to complete.
25. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 25.1) or the command mode (Step 25.2).
25.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
25.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
25.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V using the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
26.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
27.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
27.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
27.4. Enter 1
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
27.5. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
27.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form.
28. Update the growth UC major status field from GROW to OOS.
28.2. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
28.3. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
28.5. Enter u
Response: The system flashes FORM UPDATED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then the display
returns to page 1 of the ucb form.
29.2. Press the <CR> key four times to default all four fields on the trend
form.
29.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
31.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
32.2. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 1 in progress and wait until CU 1 is restored to standby before
continuing.
34. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove CU 0 from service by operating the
ROS/RST switch to the ROS position.
Response: The system displays RMV CU 0 COMPLETED
NOTE:
At the MTTY, CU 0 displays an FOFL indicator and CU 1 displays
an FONL indicator.
35.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
36. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 36.1) or the command mode (Step 36.2).
36.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
36.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
36.2. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V using the command
mode by entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
37.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
38.3. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
38.4. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
38.5. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
38.6. Enter a
Where: a = unit name of the PLU.
38.7. Enter b
Where: b = unit number of the PLU.
39. Update the PLU side pointer linkage to point to the growth UC.
39.2. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
39.3. Enter 41
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
39.4. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
39.5. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
39.6. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_number:
attribute.
39.7. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
39.9. Enter u
Response: The system flashes FORM UPDATED once in the
upper right corner of the screen.
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
40.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
40.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
40.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
40.5. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
40.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form.
41. Update the UC up pointer linkage to point to the OOS CU, and change major status
field from UNEQIP to GROW.
41.2. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
41.4. Enter 40
Response: The cursor moves to the cntrl_0 complex_name:
attribute.
41.7. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
41.8. Enter 0
Response: The system displays Change Field:
41.9. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
42.2. Enter 41
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
42.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
42.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the side unit_name: attribute.
42.5. Enter aa
Where: aa = unit name of the NLU.
42.6. Enter bb
Where: bb = unit number of the NLU.
42.8. Enter u
Response: The system flashes FORM UPDATED once in the
upper right corner of the screen.
The cursor moves to the k_complex_name:
attribute.
42.9. Enter <
Response: The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
43.2. Press the <CR> key four times to default all four fields on the trend
form.
43.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
45. At CUPS TN1821 (at EQL 28-060), remove power from CU 0 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the OFF position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER REMOVED CU 0
! CAUTION:
Wear an antistatic wrist strap while handling circuit packs to prevent damage to
components.
46. Install the UN379 UC circuit pack at EQL 19-050 for CU 0. Line up the top and
bottom of the circuit pack with the card guides and slide the pack into position with
the latch at the lower end of the faceplate open. When the circuit pack begins to
make contact with the backplane pins (this will be felt by increased resistance while
inserting the pack), the bottom of the latch should make contact with the bottom of
the unit assembly. Close the latch to push the pack into the final position.
47. At CUPS TN1821 for CU 0 (at EQL 28-060), restore power to CU 0 by operating the
ST/ON/OFF switch to the ST position and releasing to the ON position.
Response: The system displays REPT POWER RESTORED CU 0
NOTE:
During an RC session, input messages may be used via the CMD
MSG key. Return to the RC session by operating the CMD MSG
key twice.
48.2. Verify that the ATP MSG COMPL output message is received.
NOTE:
Some diagnostics may require up to 30 minutes to complete.
49. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 49.1) or the command mode (Step 49.2).
49.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
49.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
49.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V using the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
50.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
51.2. Enter u
Response: The cursor moves to the complex_name: attribute.
51.3. Enter CU
Response: The cursor moves to the k_complex_number:
attribute.
51.4. Enter 0
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_name: attribute.
51.5. Enter UC
Response: The cursor moves to the k_unit_number: attribute.
51.6. Enter 0
Response: The system completes the remainder of the form.
52. Update the growth UC major status field from GROW to OOS.
52.2. Enter c
Response: The system displays Change Field:
52.3. Enter 21
Response: The cursor moves to the major_status: attribute.
52.5. Enter u
Response: The system flashes FORM UPDATED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then the display
returns to page 1 of the ucb form.
53.2. Press the <CR> key four times to default all four fields on the trend
form.
53.3. Enter e
Response: The system flashes FORM EXECUTED once in the
upper right corner of the screen and then displays
the data entry page.
NOTE:
Neither CU 0 nor CU 1 displays a forced indicator at the MTTY.
55.3. At the MTTY, press the NORM DISP key to return to the CPDP.
56.2. At the MTTY, observe CPDP 102 and the ROP output for the restoral of
CU 0 in progress and wait until CU 0 is restored to standby before
continuing.
56.3. Allow system to soak 15 minutes before continuing.
57. Invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V by accessing the ECD using either
the menu mode (Step 57.1) or the command mode (Step 57.2).
57.1.3. Enter n
Response: The cursor moves to the journaling: attribute.
57.1.4. Enter *
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
57.2. At the MTTY, invoke the incore database low-level mode RC/V using the
command mode by entering the appropriate command.
If MML, RCV:MENU:DATA,RCVECD,DB="incore",NREVIEW;
If PDS, RCV:MENU:RCVECD,DB "incore",NREVIEW!
58.3. Enter e
Response: The system displays executing... FORM
EXECUTED
The cursor moves to the Enter Form Name:
attribute.
NOTE:
See Appendix A for the procedure to update the backup root file system.
61. At the MTTY, allow automatic maintenance requests by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, ALW:DMQ:SRC=ALL;
If PDS, ALW:DMQ:SRC ALL!
62. Create a full set of office backup tapes at this time. Use existing local procedures for
making new backup tape copies. For additional information, refer to your
applications specific instructions or to 254-303-106, System Maintenance Manual.
A
Contents
Introduction A-1
Procedure A-2
A
Introduction
The following partitions on the disk have backups (applications may have other partition
backups):
NOTE:
The partitions /dev/boot and /dev/bboot do not have a file system structure. They are
files used during the bootstrap sequence only. They can be copied with the
COPY:PTN command but cannot be mounted.
A copy can be made from the primary partitions to the backup partitions or from the backup
partitions to the primary partitions depending on which is active on the system.
Procedure
If MHD 0 or MHD 1 is listed in the output message, restore the listed MHD to service
(RST:MHD ).
2. Determine if the system is currently running on the primary or backup file systems by
entering the appropriate input command.
If MML, OP:STATUS:DATA,FILESYS;
If PDS, OP:STATUS:FILESYS!
3. Check the integrity of the disks (verifying each disk) by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, VFY:MHD=0;
If PDS, VFY:MHD 0!
Wait for a completion message and then enter the appropriate input command.
If MML, VFY:MHD=1;
If PDS, VFY:MHD 1!
NOTE:
If the disk drive is a Small Computer System Interface (SCSI) type, there is no
need to wait before requesting the second verify.
If one MHD fails, remove it from service (RMV:MHD), initialize it (INIT:MHD), and
then restore it to service (RST:MHD). If both fail, contact your technical assistance
organization. If both MHDs pass, continue to Step 4.
4. Check the integrity of the active partitions by inhibiting routine audits and then
running the FSBLK and FSLINK audits on each active partition using Step 4.1 or 4.2.
The active and inactive partitions were determined in Step 2.
If MML, INH:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, INH:AUD:ALL!
4.2. If the backup partitions are active, enter the appropriate input command.
If MML, INH:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, INH:AUD:ALL!
5. Create and verify a file named "/tmp/primary " and a file named "/tmp/backup" which
will be used as the source (SRC) and destination (DEST) filenames in the
COPY:PTN command using either the UNIX system editor (Step 5.1) or a series of
MML or PDS input commands (Step 5.2).
/dev/boot
/dev/root
/dev/etc
/dev/db
5.1.2. Create a file named /tmp/backup that contains the following lines:
/dev/bboot
/dev/broot
/dev/betc
/dev/bdb
NOTE:
Remember that applications may need additional partitions (one
partition name per line) added to /tmp/primary and /tmp/backup.
5.1.3. After using the UNIX system to create /tmp/primary and /tmp/backup,
go to Step 6.
5.2. If you do not have the UNIX system available on your machine or are not
familiar with the ed editor, you may create and verify the files using MML
or PDS input commands.
5.2.1. Verify if the file /tmp/primary exists by entering the appropriate input
command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:DATA,ALL,FN="/tmp/primary";
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:ALL,FN "/tmp/primary"!
If MML, IN:FILE:DATA,APND,FN="/tmp/primary",LINE=0!
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/boot";
IN:FILE:DATA,APND,FN="/tmp/primary",LINE=1!
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/root";
IN:FILE:DATA,APND,FN="/tmp/primary",LINE=2!
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/etc";
IN:FILE:DATA,APND,FN="/tmp/primary",LINE=3!
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/db";
If PDS, IN:FILE:APND,FN "/tmp/primary",LINE 0/
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/boot"!
IN:FILE:APND,FN "/tmp/primary",LINE 1/
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/root"!
IN:FILE:APND,FN "/tmp/primary",LINE 2/
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/etc"!
IN:FILE:APND,FN "/tmp/primary",LINE 3/
5.2.3. Verify the contents of the /tmp/primary file by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:DATA,ALL,FN="/tmp/primary";
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:ALL,FN "/tmp/primary"!
The file /tmp/primary will be output. Verify that the file has an
entry for each primary partition in the order listed as follows:
/dev/boot
/dev/root
/dev/etc
/dev/db
5.2.4. Verify if the file /tmp/backup already exists by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:DATA,ALL,FN="/tmp/backup";
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:ALL,FN "/tmp/backup"!
If MML, IN:FILE:DATA,APND,FN="/tmp/backup",LINE=0!
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/bboot";
IN:FILE:DATA,APND,FN="/tmp/backup",LINE=1!
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/broot";
IN:FILE:DATA,APND,FN="/tmp/backup",LINE=2!
Press the <CR> key. At the : prompt, type:
"/dev/betc";
IN:FILE:DATA,APND,FN="/tmp/backup",LINE=3!
Press the <CR> key. At the prompt, type:
"/dev/bdb";
5.2.6. Verify the contents of the /tmp/backup file by entering the appropriate
input command.
If MML, DUMP:FILE:DATA,ALL,FN="/tmp/backup";
If PDS, DUMP:FILE:ALL,FN "/tmp/backup"!
The file /tmp/backup will be output. Verify that the file has an
entry for each primary partition in the order listed as follows:
/dev/bboot
/dev/broot
/dev/betc
/dev/bdb
6. Copy the active partitions to the inactive partitions by using either Step 6.1 or 6.2.
NOTE:
Instead of specifying the partition names, two ordinary files containing the
partition names will be specified (one partition name per line) in the command
line.
One MHD is automatically removed from service and acts as the source disk for
the copy. After the copy completes, the Out-of-Service (OOS) MHD is restored
to service.
7. Check the integrity of the new inactive partition copies by inhibiting routine audits and
then running the FSBLK and FSLINK audits on each new partition. If the primary
partitions are active, continue to Step 7.1. If the backup partitions are active, go to
Step 7.5.
If MML, INH:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, INH:AUD:ALL!
7.2. If the file system audits report errors on any partitions, then go to Step 8
to copy and verify only the specific partition that failed.
7.3. If no file system audit errors are reported, the copy to backup partitions
was successful. Resume the scheduling of routine audits by entering
the appropriate input command.
If MML, ALW:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, ALW:AUD:ALL!
7.5. If the backup partitions are active, enter the appropriate input command.
If MML, INH:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, INH:AUD:ALL!
7.6. If the file system audits report errors on any partitions, go to Step 8 to
copy and verify only the specific partition that failed.
7.7. If no file system audit errors are reported, the copy to backup partitions
was successful. Resume the scheduling of routine audits by entering
the appropriate input command.
If MML, ALW:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, ALW:AUD:ALL!
8. Verify that audits reported a failure in Step 7. This step is only performed if the
audits reported a failure. Perform Step 8.1 to verify the active partition, Step 8.2 to
copy it, and Step 8.3 to reverify the new backup individual partition.
NOTE:
If the errors occur again while performing Step 8, contact your technical
assistance organization for advice on how to correct the problem.
If MML, INH:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, INH:AUD:ALL!
If MML, INH:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, INH:AUD:ALL!
8.3. Check the integrity of the new partition copies by inhibiting routine audits
and then running the FSBLK and FSLINK audits on each new partition.
If the primary partitions are active, continue to Step 8.3.1. If the backup
partitions are active, go to Step 8.3.5.
If MML, INH:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, INH:AUD:ALL!
8.3.2. If the file system audits report errors on any partitions, contact your
technical assistance organization for advice on how to correct the
problem.
8.3.3. If no file system audit errors are reported, the copy to active partitions
was successful. Resume the scheduling of routine audits by entering
the appropriate input command.
If MML, ALW:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, ALW:AUD:ALL!
8.3.5. If the backup partitions are active, enter the appropriate input
command.
If MML, INH:AUD:DATA,ALL;
If PDS, INH:AUD:ALL!
A
ABD
Alternate Boot Disk
ACT
Active. A unit that is currently in service.
AM
Automatic Maintenance
AM
Administrative Module
Asynchronous
A communications method in which time intervals between transmitted characters may
be of unequal length and no clock is included with the transmission. Transmission is
controlled by start and stop bits at the beginning and end of each character.
ATP
All Tests Passed
Audit
Validity checks that are performed to assure the proper operation of diagnostic control
structure and the accuracy of message and data.
B
Backplane
A large Printed Wiring Assembly (PWA) that distributes Direct Current (DC) power and
logic signals between hardware modules. Most circuit pack modules plug into the
backplane.
Baud Rate
A measure of the speed of data transfer from a computer to a peripheral device (such as
a terminal) or from one device to another. Common baud rates are 300, 1200, 4800,
and 9600. As a general guide, divide a baud rate by 10 to get the approximate number
of English characters transmitted each second.
bdj Driver
Block Device ‘‘ j ’’ Driver
BOM
Beginning of Media
BOP
Beginning of Partition
BOT
Beginning of Tape
btparm
boot time parameter
BTR
Bus Terminating Resistor
Bus
One or more conductors that transmit control signals, data, or power. A bus usually acts
as a common connection between several locations.
C
C/D
Control/Display
CATP
Conditional All Tests Passed
CC
Central Control. The control circuitry arithmetic logic unit, rotate and mask unit, general
and special registers, maintenance channel, store address translator circuit, and
optional cache memory unit that compose the CC.
CH
Channel
chopt
channel option
Command
An instruction to the UNIX system shell program ended by a carriage return. A
command is entered to instruct the computer system to perform one or more tasks.
classdef
class definition
CPDP
Common Processor Display Page
CPU
Central Processing Unit. A 32-bit MIPS* R2000A Reduced Instruction Set Controller
(RISC) microprocessor clocked at 16.67 MHz. The term CPU also refers to the logical
processor consisting of the three CPU modules.
CR
Carriage Return
CU
Control Unit. That portion of the computer which is switched in and out of service as a
unit. A CU includes a CC, a Main Store (MAS), a Direct Memory Access (DMA) unit
(when equipped), the Input/Output (I/O) channels, and the power control unit.
CUPS
Control Unit Power Switch
D
DAP
Display Administration Process. A process that controls the graphic displays on the
user Maintenance Cathode-Ray Tube (MCRT) terminal. It accepts requests from other
processes via messages, changes its internal representation of the displayed page, and
then displays it on the terminal.
DAT
Digital Audio Tape
DC
Direct Current
DCI
Dual Serial Channel Computer Interconnect
dciadd
addition of dual serial channel computer interconnect
dcidel
deletion of dual serial channel computer interconnect
DCIDIP
DCI Display Process
dciopt
dual serial channel computer interconnect option
DCN
Device Control Number
Demand Phase
A phase that has a very long execution time and/or requires manual action to complete
successfully. To execute a demand phase, the phase number must be specified or
included in a range of phases, and the Routine Exercise (REX) or Demand Exercise
(DEX) options must not be specified.
DEX
Demand Exercise
DFC
Disk File Controller. A unit that controls the operation of a portion of the disk storage
facility of the UNIX Real-Time Reliable (RTR) operating system. This unit interfaces to
an Input/Output (I/O) channel and to a Moving Head Disk (MHD) drive.
DFSA
Disk File System Access
DGN
Diagnostic
Differential SCSI
A receiver/driver design for the Small Computer System Interface (SCSI) Bus (SBUS)
that provides for a maximum bus length of 25 meters (versus 6 meters for the
single-ended SBUS). The differential SBUS is used with the optional 9-track tape drive.
DMA
Direct Memory Access. A method used to perform high-speed data transfers between
memory locations without CPU involvement.
DMAC
Direct Memory Access Controller. The system unit that provides Main Store (MAS)
access control for Input/Output (I/O) devices without requiring direct control from the CC.
DMQ
Deferred Maintenance Queue
DSCH
Dual Serial Channel. A system component that provides serial interfaces for up to 16
devices.
DST
Destination
E
EAI
Emergency Action Interface. The EAI provides an interface between a CU and a serial
data link for effecting various manual override functions such as ‘‘force on-line,’’ ‘‘stop
and switch,’’ and so forth. The EAI is part of the maintenance interface.
ECD
Equipment Configuration Database. A database that describes the physical and logical
configurations of the 3B21D computer and the peripheral hardware. It also contains
configuration and control information for the audit and operator interface software
systems.
EIA
Electronic Industries Association
EIA-232-D
An Electronics Industries Association standard for serial binary communications. The
January 1987 revision of this standard replaces the EIA recommended standard
RS-232-C.
EQL
Equipment Location
errthld
error threshold
F
FOFL
Force Off-Line
FONL
Force On-Line
G
GB
Gigabyte. One billion bytes.
Generic
A release of hardware or software.
Grow
The state of a unit while it is being added to the system (grown).
H
HA
Host Adapter
HA-OMP
High Availability - Operations and Maintenance Platform
Host
A computer system that is configured to share resources, such as disks and printers, in
a networked environment.
HSD
High-Speed Synchronous Data Link
HSDC
High-Speed Synchronous Data Link Controller
I
ID
Identification
Incore Database
A database read from a disk that is resident (incore) in the machine.
iopadd
addition of input/output processor
IP
Information Product
Initialization
An action taken to provide the system with an operating configuration.
Initialization Level
A value of initialization level counter. The severity of the action taken to recover the
system integrity is dependent on the counter value. The higher the value, the more
drastic the action taken to recover the system.
Interrupt
A signal, caused by a break or an interrupt character, that normally terminates a
process. It is also a signal generated by a hardware condition or a peripheral device.
I/O
Input/Output
IOP
Input/Output Processor. A front-end processor that permits the connection of a variety
of data terminals utilizing a variety of line protocols. The IOP contains a peripheral
interface controller, IOP interface, and two microprocessor communities. Each
microprocessor community connects to a number of data terminals.
IOPPS
Input/Output Processor Power Switch
L
LED
Light-Emitting Diode. A semiconductor that emits visible light.
Link
An entry for an existing file to a directory.
logdev
logical device
M
Maintenance Terminal
The terminal that is used for exchange of maintenance information/commands between
the maintenance person and the computer. It is also referred to as Maintenance
Cathode-Ray Tube (MCRT) or Maintenance Teletypewriter (MTTY).
Manual Input Commands
The Man-Machine Language (MML) and Program Documentation Standard (PDS)
format input commands that allow the user to query and request system services.
MAS
Main Store. The system unit that provides storage for program instructions and data. It
is composed of solid-state memory devices and provides up to 4 megabytes of storage.
MASC
Main Store Controller. The circuit that provides control interface between the main store
bus and the memory devices.
Mb
Megabit.
MB
Megabyte. When referring to disk drives, a megabyte is 1 million bytes. When referring
to main store memory, a megabyte is 220 bytes (1,048,576 bytes).
MC
Microcontrol or Microcontroller. The portion of the CC that controls the sequencing of
microstore and decoding of microinstructions. MC provides control signals for the CC
circuitry. The CC component that provides a serial access between CUs.
MCC
Master Control Center
MCRT
Maintenance Cathode-Ray Tube
MDCT or mdct
Minor Device Chain Table
Message
The mechanism that transfers data from one process to another.
MHD
Moving Head Disk
MHDC
Moving Head Disk Controller
MML
Man-Machine Language
MSGS File
An ordered list of executable commands used to install changes to the system using
field update.
MT
Magnetic Tape
MTTY
Maintenance Teletypewriter
MTTYC
Maintenance Teletypewriter Controller
N
Network
The hardware and software that connect computer systems, permitting electronic
communications between the systems and associated peripherals.
NLU
Next Logical Unit
NR
Not Required
O
ODIN
On-line Data INtegrity system
OFL
Off-Line. The unit that is not in active control of the system configuration and execution
but is actively performing off-line functions; for example, executing diagnostics.
On-Line
The unit that is in active control of the system configuration and execution. Its mate, the
off-line CU, may be active (executing diagnostics) but is not in control.
Operating System
A set of programs (or software) that controls the computer system. The nucleus of the
UNIX RTR operating system is the kernel, which manages the resources of the
computer. The operating system takes care of such things as I/O procedures, process
scheduling, and the file system, which relieves user programs of these tasks.
OOS
Out of Service
P
Page
A fixed length, 4-Kb block that has a virtual address and can be transferred between
main and secondary storage.
Paging
The process by which programs are divided into pages and transferred between main
and secondary.
PC
Peripheral Controller
PDS
Program Documentation Standard
PLU
Previous Logical Unit
Process
An executing program with its own input, output, and ‘‘parent’’ program that initiated it.
PU
Peripheral Unit
PWA
Printed Wiring Assembly
Q
Queue
A waiting list usually consisting of processes or tasks waiting for processor time to
execute.
R
RC
Recent Change
RC/V
Recent Change and Verify. A procedure used for creating or modifying records in the
ECD.
Real-Time
Pertains to computation performed while the related physical process is taking place.
Results of the computation can be used in guiding the physical process.
REX
Routine Exercise
RISC
Reduced Instruction Set Controller
Root
The directory that constitutes the origin of the directory hierarchy in a file system.
Specifically, the origin for the file system with the pathname.
ROP
Receive-Only Printer. An output device printer.
ROS
Request Out-of-Service
Routine Exercise Phase
The diagnostic phase which is run automatically when the requesting process is REX,
when specified in the command line, or when REX or DEX options are used.
ROS/RST
Request Out-of-Service/Restore. A two-position rocker switch that sends a request via
scan points to remove the associated unit from service or to restore the associated unit
to service.
RQIP
Request In Progress
RST
Restore
RTR
Real-Time Reliable
S
SBUS
Small Computer System Interface Bus
SC
Scan Point
SCSD
Scanner and Signal Distributor
scsdbody
scanner and signal distributor option block body
SCSDC
Scanner and Signal Distributor Controller
SCSDC16
Scanner and Signal Distributor Controller 16
SCSDOPT
An ECD record that gives the option name for the SCSD PC in the IOP.
scsdopt
scanner and signal distributor option block head
SCSI
Small Computer System Interface. An interface standard (ANSI* X3.131-1986) for an
I/O bus used to connect peripheral devices and processors (SCSI devices). A SCSI
device requests access to (and gains control of) the SBUS in order to perform data
transfers with other SCSI devices using a well-defined set of commands.
scsiadd
addition of small computer system interface
SD
Signal Distributor
SDC
Store Data Control
SDL
Synchronous Data Link
sdladd
addition of synchronous data link
sdldel
deletion of synchronous data link
SDLC
Synchronous Data Link Controller
sdlcadd
addition of synchronous data link controller
sdlcdel
deletion of synchronous data link controller
Serial Channel
A system component that provides a 16- or 32-bit serial data interface to I/O devices.
sgen
system generation
SIMM
Single In-line Memory Module
Single-Ended SCSI
Receiver/driver design for the SBUS that allows extremely fast data transfer rates over
the SBUS. The total bus length is limited to 6 meters, including PWA wiring and cables.
This is the standard SBUS used to control disk and cartridge tape modules.
SMD
Storage Module Drive
SPU
SCSI Peripheral Unit
SRC
Source (bus)
STBY
Standby. The state of a unit that is operational and available for immediate service. It is
either not communicating or is not the active half of a duplex pair of devices.
STK
Storage Tek
STLWS
Supplementary Trunk and Line Work Station
ST/ON/OFF
Start/On/Off. A three-position rocker switch.
Synchronous
A communications method in which there is a constant time between successive bits,
characters, or events. The timing is achieved by the sharing of a clock signal between
the transmitter and receiver.
System Memory
The combination of MAS memory and all other memory for the system.
System Update
The procedure used to introduce an entire new generic, as opposed to selected fixes,
on the 3B21D computer.
T
TTY
Teletypewriter
ttyadd
addition of teletypewriter
ttydel
deletion of teletypewriter
TTYC
Teletypewriter Controller. The control circuit that interfaces to an IOP and provides
communication to two TTYs.
ttycadd
addition of teletypewriter controller
ttycdel
deletion of teletypewriter controller
TTYPC
TTY Peripheral Controller
U
UC
Utility Circuit. The optional system unit that provides address and data matchers and
transfer trace capability. This unit is used for software debugging.
UCB or ucb
Unit Control Block
UCL
Unconditional
ularp
user level automatic restart process
H
E Hexadecimal Notation, xxvi
How to Comment on Information Product, xxix
ECD, 18-15, 22-2, 23-2, 23-3, 24-2, 26-2 How to Use This Information Product, xx
Enter link data to the ECD, 23-3 HSDC circuit pack, 25-4
EQL 28-130, 21-16 HSDC degrowth, 7-1
EQL for CU 0, 2-7 HSDC degrowth, procedure, 7-2
EQL for CU 1, 2-9 HSDC growth, 8-1
Equipage values, 12-11 HSDC growth, procedure, 8-2
Equipment configuration database, 22-3, 24-3,
27-3, 28-3
Equipment Locations, xxvi
errthld form field values, 4-10
Exit RC, 1-15, 2-19, 4-42, 5-55, 6-91, 9-11,
10-14, 12-23, 13-27, 13-43, 14-27, 14-43,
16-24, 18-19, 19-22, 20-16, 22-6, 23-6, 24-7,
25-6, 26-6, 27-7, 28-7, 29-6, 30-17, 31-38
I L
Invoke incore database high-level mode logdev form field values, 4-12
RC/V, 22-2, 23-2, 24-2, 25-2, 26-2, 27-2, 28-2 logdev record, 18-15, 18-16, 19-17, 19-18
Invoke incore database high-level mode using Logical device names, 18-16
command mode, 1-4, 2-5, 9-3, 10-4, 20-8,
29-3
Invoke incore database high-level mode using
menu mode, 1-4, 2-4, 9-2, 10-3, 20-7, 29-2 M
Invoke incore database low-level mode
RC/V, 3-3, 4-3
Mandatory Customer Information, xxix
Invoke incore database low-level mode using
mdct form field values, 4-9
command mode, 5-3, 8-3, 12-12, 16-3, 17-3,
mdct record, 21-5
18-3, 19-3, 26-3, 27-3, 30-4, 30-11, 30-17,
mdct records, 19-19
31-8, 31-11, 31-19, 31-25, 31-37
Memory growth, 12-1
Invoke incore database low-level mode using
Memory growth, procedure, 12-2
menu mode, 5-3, 8-3, 12-12, 16-3, 17-3, 18-3,
Menu mode, 1-4, 2-4, 5-3, 8-3, 9-2, 10-3, 12-12,
19-3, 26-2, 27-2, 28-2, 30-4, 30-11, 30-16,
16-3, 17-3, 18-3, 19-3, 20-7, 21-3, 26-2, 27-2,
31-7, 31-11, 31-19, 31-24, 31-33, 31-37
28-2, 29-2, 30-4, 30-11, 30-16, 31-7, 31-11,
Invoke the incore database low-level mode
31-19, 31-24, 31-33, 31-37
RC/V using command mode, 31-33
MHD, 20-1, 20-7
IOP, 20-7
MT, 18-15, 18-16
IOP unit degrowth, 9-1
MT UCB, 18-12
IOP unit degrowth, procedure, 9-2
MT UCB cntrl pointer, 19-14
IOP unit growth, 10-1
MTTYC, 13-1
IOP unit growth, procedure, 10-2
MTTYC (9600 baud ROP) conversion, 13-1
IOP/SCSI peripheral unit growth (growth
MTTYC 1 ucb form field values, 13-8, 14-8
shelf), 11-1
MTTYC ABD conversion, 14-1
IOP/SCSI peripheral unit growth (growth shelf),
procedure, 11-2
IOP/SPU growth, configuration, 11-2
IOPPS, 23-4
IOPPS EQLs, 7-12, 8-10, 16-11, 17-10 N
Next logical unit, 18-9, 18-11, 19-11
NLU, 16-5, 17-4, 18-9, 18-11, 19-11, 19-13
J
Jumper location, 20-13
O
Obtain UCB listing, 24-3
K
KLWcc circuit pack, 11-2
KLWmm circuit pack, 12-1, 12-10
SDL, 22-1
sdladd form, 23-4
P SDLC, 24-1, 24-6
SDLC circuit pack, 25-4
Peripheral cabinet growth, 15-1 SDLC degrowth, 24-1
Peripheral cabinet growth, procedure, 15-2 SDLC growth, 25-1
PLU, 16-5, 17-4, 18-9, 19-4, 19-11, 19-12 sdlcadd form, 25-4, 25-5
PLU UCB side pointer, 19-12 Signal distributor controller, 21-1
Port switches, 21-15 Small computer system interface, 19-1
Previous logical unit, 16-5, 17-4, 19-4 SPU, 20-1, 20-3, 20-7, 21-1
Procedure, A-2 SPU configurations, 20-4
Processor cabinet, 20-3 Synchronous data link, 22-1
Synchronous data link controller, 24-1
Synchronous data link controller degrowth, 24-1
Synchronous data link controller growth, 25-1
Synchronous data link degrowth, 22-1
R Synchronous data link growth, 23-1